blob: b3ac72be62ec0c60e63931018f7f1b8777a80bce [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaubccc91d2021-07-17 12:35:11 +02007 2021/07/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200805Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
806See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
807
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200808The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
809expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100810
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
812 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200813 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200814 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200815 - a question mark ('!') preceeding any of the non-empty elements above, and
816 which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200817 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
818 from left to right until one returns false
819 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
820 from right to left until one returns true
821
822Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
823operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824
825The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
826
827 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
828 exists, regardless of its contents
829
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200830 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
831 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
832 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
833
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200834 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
835 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
836
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200837 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
838 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
839 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
840 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
841
842 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
843 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
844 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
845 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
846
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200847Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200849 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
850 listen mwcli_px
851 bind :1111
852 ...
853 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100854
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
856 bind :80
857 .endif
858
859 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200860 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200861 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200863 .endif
864
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200865 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200866 bind :443 ssl crt ...
867 .endif
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
870 profiling.memory on
871 .endif
872
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200873 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
874 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200877Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100878
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200879 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
881 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
882 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
883
884Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
885"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
886fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
887provide advice to the user.
888
889Example:
890
891 .if "${A}"
892 .if "${B}"
893 .notice "A=1, B=1"
894 .elif "${C}"
895 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
896 .elif "${D}"
897 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
898 .else
899 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
900 .endif
901 .else
902 .notice "A=0"
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200905 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
906 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
907
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100908
9092.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200910----------------
911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100912Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
914otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
915numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
916for every keyword. Supported units are :
917
918 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
919 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
920 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
921 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
922 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
923 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
924
925
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009262.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200927-------------
928
929 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
930 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
931 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
932 global
933 daemon
934 maxconn 256
935
936 defaults
937 mode http
938 timeout connect 5000ms
939 timeout client 50000ms
940 timeout server 50000ms
941
942 frontend http-in
943 bind *:80
944 default_backend servers
945
946 backend servers
947 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
948
949
950 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
951 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
952 global
953 daemon
954 maxconn 256
955
956 defaults
957 mode http
958 timeout connect 5000ms
959 timeout client 50000ms
960 timeout server 50000ms
961
962 listen http-in
963 bind *:80
964 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
965
966
967Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
968
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100969 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200970
971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009723. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973--------------------
974
975Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
976are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
977of them have command-line equivalents.
978
979The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
980
981 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200982 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200984 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200987 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200988 - description
989 - deviceatlas-json-file
990 - deviceatlas-log-level
991 - deviceatlas-separator
992 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200993 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900994 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - gid
996 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100997 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200998 - h1-case-adjust
999 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001000 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001001 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001002 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001003 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001004 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001006 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001009 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001010 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001011 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001012 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001014 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001015 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001016 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001017 - presetenv
1018 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019 - uid
1020 - ulimit-n
1021 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001022 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001023 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001025 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-options
1030 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001031 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-options
1033 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001034 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001035 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001036 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001038 - 51degrees-data-file
1039 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001040 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001041 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001042 - wurfl-data-file
1043 - wurfl-information-list
1044 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001045 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001046 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001049 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001050 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001052 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001053 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001054 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001055 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001056 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001057 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001058 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001059 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060 - noepoll
1061 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001062 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001063 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001064 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001065 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001066 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001067 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001068 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001070 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001071 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001072 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001073 - tune.buffers.limit
1074 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001075 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001076 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001077 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001078 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001079 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001080 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001081 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001082 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001083 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001084 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001085 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001086 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001087 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001088 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1089 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001090 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001091 - tune.maxaccept
1092 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001093 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001094 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001095 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001096 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1097 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001098 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1099 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001100 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001101 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001102 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001103 - tune.sndbuf.client
1104 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001105 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001106 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001107 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001108 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001109 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001110 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001111 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001112 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001113 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001114 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1116 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1117 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001118 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1119 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001123 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124
1125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001127------------------------------------
1128
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001129ca-base <dir>
1130 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001131 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1132 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1133 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135chroot <jail dir>
1136 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1137 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1138 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1139 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1140 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001141 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001142
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001144 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1146 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1147 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1148 set. These sets have the format
1149
1150 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1151
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001152 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1153 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001155 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001156 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1157 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001158 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1159 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1160 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1161 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1162 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1163 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1164 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1165 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1166 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1167 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001168
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001169 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1170 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1171 on the machine's word size.
1172
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001173 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001174 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1175 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1176 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1177 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1178 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1179 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001181 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1182 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1183 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1184 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001186 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1188 # first 4 CPUs
1189
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001190 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1191 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001192 # word size.
1193
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1195 # and so on.
1196 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1197 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1201 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1202 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1203 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001204
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001205 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1206 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1207 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001209crt-base <dir>
1210 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001211 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1212 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001213
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214daemon
1215 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1216 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001217 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1218 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001221 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1223 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1224 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1225 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1226 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1227 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1228 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1229 not start with a slash ('/'):
1230 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1231 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1232
1233 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1234 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1235 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1236 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1237 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1238 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1239 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1240 each of them.
1241
1242 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1243 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1244 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1245 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1246 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1247 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1248 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1249 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1250
1251 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1252 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001253 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001254 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1255 made easily relocatable.
1256
1257 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1258 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1259 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1260 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1261 consistent across all configuration files.
1262
1263 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1264 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1265 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1266 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1267 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1268 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1269 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1270 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1271
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001272deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1273 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001274 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001275
1276deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001277 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001278 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1279
1280deviceatlas-separator <char>
1281 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1282 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1283
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001284deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001285 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1286 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1287 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001288
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001289expose-experimental-directives
1290 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1291 the config file will be rejected.
1292
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001293external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001294 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1295 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001296 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1297 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1298 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1299 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1300 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001301
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001303 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1305 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001306 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001307 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001309
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001310group <group name>
1311 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1312 See also "gid" and "user".
1313
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001314hard-stop-after <time>
1315 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1316
1317 Arguments :
1318 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1319 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1320 SIGUSR1 signal.
1321
1322 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1323 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1324 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1325
1326 Example:
1327 global
1328 hard-stop-after 30s
1329
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001330h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1331 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1332 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1333 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1334 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001335 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001336 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1337 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1338 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1339 specified in a proxy.
1340
1341 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1342 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1343 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1344 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1345 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1346 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1347 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1348
1349 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1350 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1351 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1352 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1353 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1354
1355 Example:
1356 global
1357 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1358
1359 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1360 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1361
1362h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1363 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1364 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1365 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1366 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1367 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1368 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1369 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1370 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1371
1372 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1373 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1374 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1375
1376 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1377 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1378
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001380 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1382 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1383 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1384 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1385 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1386 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1387 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001388 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001389 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1390 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1391 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1392 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1393 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1394 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1395 disable it.
1396
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001397insecure-setuid-wanted
1398 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1399 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1400 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1401 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1406 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001407 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001408 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1409 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1410 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1411 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1412
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001413issuers-chain-path <dir>
1414 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1415 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1416 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001417 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001418 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1419 "issuers-chain-path".
1420 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1421 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1422 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1423 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1424 will share the chain in memory.
1425
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001426h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1427 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1428 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1429 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1430 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1431 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1432 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1433 the keyword with "no'.
1434
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001435localpeer <name>
1436 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1437 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1438 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1439 the configuration parsing.
1440
1441 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1442 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1443
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001444log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001445 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001446 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001448 configured with "log global".
1449
1450 <address> can be one of:
1451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001452 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001453 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1454 port).
1455
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001456 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1457 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1458 port).
1459
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001460 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001461 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1462 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001463 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001464
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001465 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1466 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1467 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1468 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1469 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1470 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1471 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1472 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1473 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1474 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001475 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001476 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1477 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1478 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001479 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1480 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001481
1482 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1483 "fd@2", see above.
1484
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001485 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1486 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1487 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1488 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1489 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1490
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001491 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1492 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001493
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001494 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1495 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1496 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1497 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1498 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1499 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1500 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1501 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1502 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1503 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001504 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1505 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001506
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001507 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1508 one of the following :
1509
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001510 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1511 field is stripped. This is the default.
1512 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1513 rfc3164.
1514
1515 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001516 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1517
1518 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1519 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1520
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001521 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1522 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1523 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1524 designed to be used with a local log server.
1525
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001526 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1527 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1528 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1529 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1530 logger consumes.
1531
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001532 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1533 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1534 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1535 used with a local log server.
1536
1537 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1538 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1539 designed to be used with a local log server.
1540
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001541 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1542 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1543 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1544 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1545
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001546 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1547 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1548 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1549 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1550 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1551
1552 <sample_size>
1553 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1554 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1555 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1556 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1557 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1558
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001559 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001560
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001561 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1562 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1563 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1564
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001565 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1566 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1567 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1568 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
1570 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001571 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1572 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1573 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1574 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1575 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1576 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001578 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001580log-send-hostname [<string>]
1581 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1582 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1583 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1584 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1585 the logs.
1586
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001587log-tag <string>
1588 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1589 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1590 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001591 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001592
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001593lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001594 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1595 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1596 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1597 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1598 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1599 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001600 used multiple times.
1601
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001602lua-load-per-thread <file>
1603 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1604 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1605 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1606 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1607 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1608 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1609 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1610 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1611 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1612 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1613 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1614 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1615 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1616 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1617 times.
1618
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001619lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1620 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1621 variable.
1622 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1623 to "path".
1624
1625 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1626 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1627 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1628 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1629 will be checked earlier.
1630
1631 As an example by specifying the following path:
1632
1633 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1634 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1635
1636 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1637 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1638 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1639 paths if that does not exist either.
1640
1641 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1642 documentation.
1643
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001644master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001645 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1646 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1647 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001648 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001649 or daemon mode.
1650
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001651 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1652 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1653 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1654 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1655 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001657 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001659mworker-max-reloads <number>
1660 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001661 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001662 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1663 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1664 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1665
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001666nbthread <number>
1667 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001668 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1669 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1670 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1671 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1672 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1673 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1674 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001675
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001676numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001677 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1679 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1680 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1681 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1682 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1683 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1684 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1685 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001688 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1689 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1690 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1691 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001693pp2-never-send-local
1694 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1695 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1696 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1697 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1698 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1699 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1700 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1701 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1702 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1703 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1704 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1705
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001706presetenv <name> <value>
1707 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1708 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1709 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1710 and "unsetenv".
1711
1712resetenv [<name> ...]
1713 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1714 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1715 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1716 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1717 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1718 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1719 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1720 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1721
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001722stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001723 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1724 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1725 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001726
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001727server-state-base <directory>
1728 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001729 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1730 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001731
1732server-state-file <file>
1733 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1734 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1735 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1736 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1737 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1738 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1739 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1740 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001741 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1742 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001743
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001744set-var <var-name> <expr>
1745 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1746 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1747 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1748 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1749 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1750 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1751 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1752 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1753 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1754
1755 Example:
1756 global
1757 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1758 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1759 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1760
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001761setenv <name> <value>
1762 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1763 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1764 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1765 and "unsetenv".
1766
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001767set-dumpable
1768 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001769 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1770 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1771 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1772 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1773 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1774 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1775 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1776 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1777 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1778 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1779 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1780 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1781 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1782 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1783 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001784 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001785 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001786
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001787ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1789 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001790 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001791 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001792 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1793 information and recommendations see e.g.
1794 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1795 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1796 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1797 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001798
1799ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1801 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1802 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1803 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1804 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001805 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1806 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1807 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001808 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001809
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001810ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1812 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1813 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1814 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1815 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1816
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001817ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1819 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1820 keyword to see available options.
1821
1822 Example:
1823 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001824 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001825
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001826ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1828 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001829 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001830 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001831 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1832 information and recommendations see e.g.
1833 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1834 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1835 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1836 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1837 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001838
1839ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1841 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1842 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1843 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1844 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1846 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1847 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1848 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001849
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001850ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1852 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1853 keyword to see available options.
1854
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001855ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1857 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1858 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001859 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001860 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001861 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1862 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1863 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1864 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001865 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1866 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1867 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1868
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001869ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1870 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1871 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001872 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001873 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1875
1876 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001877
1878 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1879 and won't try to remove them.
1880
1881 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1882
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001883ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001884 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001885 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1886 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1887 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001888
1889 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1890 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1891 optimize the startup time.
1892
1893 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1894 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1895 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1896
1897 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001898 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001899
1900 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001901 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1902 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001903
1904 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1905 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1906 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1907 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1908 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001909 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001910
1911 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001912 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001913 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1914 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1915 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1916 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1917 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001918 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001919
1920 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1921
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001922 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001923 a cert bundle.
1924
1925 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1926 separately in several "crt".
1927
1928 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1929 since files are loading separately.
1930
1931 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1932 required to commit them.
1933
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001934 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001935 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001936
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001937 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1938 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1939 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001940
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001941 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1942 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1943 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944
1945 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001946 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1947 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001949 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1950 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1951
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001952 The default behavior is "all".
1953
1954 Example:
1955 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1956 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1957 ssl-load-extra-files none
1958
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001959 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1960 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001962ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1963 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1964 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1965 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1966
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001967ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001968 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1970 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1971 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1972 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1973 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1974 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001975 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001976
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001977stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1978 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1979 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1980 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001981 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001982 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001983
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001984 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1985 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1986 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001987
1988stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1989 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1990 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001991 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001992
1993stats maxconn <connections>
1994 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1995 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001997uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001998 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2000 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2001 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2002
2003ulimit-n <number>
2004 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2005 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2006 option.
2007
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002008unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2009 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2010
2011 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2012 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2013 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2014 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2015 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002016 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002017 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2018 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2019 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2020 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2021
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002022unsetenv [<name> ...]
2023 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2024 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2025 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2026 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2027 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2028 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2029 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2030
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002031user <user name>
2032 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2033 See also "uid" and "group".
2034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002035node <name>
2036 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2037
2038 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2039 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2040 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2041 traffic.
2042
2043description <text>
2044 Add a text that describes the instance.
2045
2046 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2047 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2048 "<" and ">" characters.
2049
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205051degrees-data-file <file path>
2051 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002053
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002054 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002055 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2056
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000205751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2059 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2060 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2061
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002062 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002063 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2064
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002066 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2067 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2068
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002069 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002070 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2071
207251degrees-cache-size <number>
2073 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2074 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2075 By default, this cache is disabled.
2076
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002077 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002078 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2079
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002080wurfl-data-file <file path>
2081 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2082 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2083
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002084 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002085 with USE_WURFL=1.
2086
2087wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2088 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2089 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2090 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2091
2092 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2093
2094 Valid WURFL properties are:
2095 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2096
2097 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2098 device.
2099
2100 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2101 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2102
2103 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2104 particular web request.
2105
2106 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2107 used Libwurfl API version.
2108
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002109 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2110 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2111
2112 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2113 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2114
2115 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002117 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002118 with USE_WURFL=1.
2119
2120wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2121 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2122 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002124 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002125 with USE_WURFL=1.
2126
2127wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2128 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2129 thus before the chroot.
2130
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002131 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002132 with USE_WURFL=1.
2133
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002134wurfl-cache-size <size>
2135 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2136 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002137 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002138 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002140 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002141 with USE_WURFL=1.
2142
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002143strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002144 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002145 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2146 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002147 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002148 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021503.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002151-----------------------
2152
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002153busy-polling
2154 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2155 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2156 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2157 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2158 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2159 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2160 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2161 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2162 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2163 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2164 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2165 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2166 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2167 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2168 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2169 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2170 "poll" pollers.
2171
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002172 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2173 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2174 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2175
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002176max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002177 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002178 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2179 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2180 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2181 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2182 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2183 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2184 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186maxconn <number>
2187 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2188 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2189 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002190 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2191 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2192 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2193 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002194 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2195 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2196 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2197 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2198 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2199 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002200
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002201maxconnrate <number>
2202 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2203 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2204 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2205 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2206 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2207 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2208 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2209 fairness.
2210
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002211maxcomprate <number>
2212 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002213 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002214 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2215 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2216 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002217 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002218 default value.
2219
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002220maxcompcpuusage <number>
2221 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2222 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2223 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002224 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2225 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2226 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2227 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002228
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002229maxpipes <number>
2230 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2231 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2232 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2233 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2234 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2235 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2236
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002237maxsessrate <number>
2238 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2239 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2240 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2241 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2242 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2243 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2244 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2245 fairness.
2246
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002247maxsslconn <number>
2248 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2249 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2250 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2251 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2252 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2253 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2254 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002255 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2256 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2257 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2258 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002259 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002260 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2261 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002262
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002263maxsslrate <number>
2264 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2265 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2266 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2267 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2268 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2269 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2270 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2271 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2272 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2273 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2274
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002275maxzlibmem <number>
2276 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2277 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2278 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002279 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2280 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2281 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2282
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002283noepoll
2284 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2285 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002286 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
2288nokqueue
2289 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2290 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2291 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2292
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002293noevports
2294 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2295 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2296 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2297 also "nopoll".
2298
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299nopoll
2300 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2301 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002303 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2304 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002306nosplice
2307 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002308 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002309 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002310 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002311 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2312 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2313 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2314 "option splice-response".
2315
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002316nogetaddrinfo
2317 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2318 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2319
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002320noreuseport
2321 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2322 command line argument "-dR".
2323
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002324profiling.memory { on | off }
2325 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2326 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2327 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2328 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2329 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2330 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2331 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2332 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2333 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2334
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002335profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2336 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2337 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2338 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2339 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002340 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2342 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2343 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2344 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2345
2346 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2347 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2348 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2349 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2350 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002351 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2352 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2353 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2354 CLI.
2355
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002356spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002357 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2358 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2359 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2360 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2361 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2362 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002363
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002364ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002365 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002366 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002367 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002368 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002369 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2370 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2371 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2373 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002374 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2375 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2376 openssl configuration file uses:
2377 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2378
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002379ssl-mode-async
2380 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002381 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002382 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2383 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002384 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002385 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002386 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002387
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002388tune.buffers.limit <number>
2389 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2390 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2391 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2392 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2393 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002394 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002395 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2396 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2397 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2398 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2399 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2400 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2401 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2402 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002403 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002404
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002405tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2406 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2407 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2408 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002410
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002411tune.bufsize <number>
2412 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2413 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2414 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2415 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2416 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2417 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2418 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002419 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2420 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002421 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002422 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002424 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2425 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002426
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002427tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2428 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2429 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2430 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2431 this value. The default value is 1.
2432
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002433tune.fail-alloc
2434 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2435 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2436 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2437 gracefully.
2438
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002439tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2440 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2441 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2442 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2443 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2444 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2445
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002446tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2447 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2448 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2449 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2450 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2451 change it.
2452
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002453tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2454 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002455 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002457 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2458 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2459 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2460 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2461 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2462
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002463tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2464 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2465 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2466 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2467 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2468 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002469 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002470 recommended not to change this value.
2471
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002472tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002473 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002474 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002476 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2477 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2478 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2479 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2480
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002481tune.http.cookielen <number>
2482 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2483 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2484 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2485 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2486 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2487 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2488 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2489 to change this value.
2490
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002491tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002492 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2493 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002494 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002495 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002496 configuration directives too.
2497 The default value is 1024.
2498
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002499tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2500 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2501 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2502 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2503 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2504 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2505 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002506 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2507 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2508 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002509
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002510tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2511 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2512 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2513 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2514 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2515 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2516 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002517 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2518 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2519 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2520 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2521 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002522
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002523tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002524 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002525 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2526 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2527 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2528 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002529 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002530 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002531 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002532 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2533
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002534tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2535 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2536 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2537 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2538 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2539 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2540 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2541 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2542 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2543 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2544
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002545tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2546 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002547 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002548 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2549 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002550 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2552 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2553
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002554tune.lua.maxmem
2555 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2556 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2557 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2558 memory.
2559
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002560tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2561 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002562 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2563 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002564 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002565
2566tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2567 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2568 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2569 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2570 check servers.
2571
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002572tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2573 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2574 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2575 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002576 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002577
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002578tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002579 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2580 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002581 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2582 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2583 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2584 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2585 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2586 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2587 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2588 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2589 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002590
2591tune.maxpollevents <number>
2592 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2593 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2594 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2595 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2596 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2597
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002598tune.maxrewrite <number>
2599 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2600 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2601 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2602 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2603 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2604 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2605 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2606 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2607 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2608 bufsize.
2609
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002610tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2611 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2612 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2613 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2614 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2615 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2616 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2617 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2618 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2619 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002620 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2621 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002622 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2623 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2624 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2625 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2626 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2627 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2628 setting this parameter to 0.
2629
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002630tune.pipesize <number>
2631 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2632 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2633 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2634 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2635 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2636 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2637
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002638tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2639 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002640 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002641 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2642 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2643 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2644 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002645 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002646
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002647tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2648 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002649 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002650 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2651 default is 20.
2652
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002653tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2654tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2655 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2656 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2657 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002658 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002659 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002660 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2661 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2662
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002663tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002665 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2666 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2667 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2668 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2669
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002670tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002671 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002672 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2673 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2674 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2675 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2676 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2677 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2678 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002679
2680tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2681 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002683 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2684 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2685 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2686 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2687 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2688 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2689 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002690
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002691tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2692tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2693 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2694 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2695 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002696 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002697 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002698 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2699 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2700 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2701 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002702 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002703
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002704tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002705 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002706 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2707 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2708 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2709 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2710 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2711 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2712 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2713 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2714 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002715 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2716 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002717
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002718tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002719 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002720 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2721 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2722 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2723 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2724 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2725
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002726tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2727 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2728 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2729 performances. This is disabled by default.
2730
2731 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2732 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2733
2734 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2735
2736 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2737
2738 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2739
2740 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2741 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2742 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2743
2744 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2745 converted.
2746
2747 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2748 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2749 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2750 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2751 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2752 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2753 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002754 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2755 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002756
2757 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2758
2759 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2760 only need this line:
2761
2762 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2763
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002764tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2765 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002766 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002767 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2768 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2769 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2770 being used for too long.
2771
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002772tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2773 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2774 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2775 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2776 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2777 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2778 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2779 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2780 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2781 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2782 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002783 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002784 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002785
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002786tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2787 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2788 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2789 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2790 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002791 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2793 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002794 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2795 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002796
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002797tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2798 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2799 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2800 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2801 1000 entries.
2802
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002803tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2804 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2805 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2806 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002808tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002809tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002810tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2811tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2812tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002813 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2814 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2815 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2816 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2817 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2818 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2819 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2820 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002821
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002822 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2823 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2824 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2825 all available space is consumed.
2826 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2827 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2828 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002830tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2831 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002832 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002833 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002834 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002835 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2836
2837tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2838 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2839 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002840 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2841 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028433.3. Debugging
2844--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002846quiet
2847 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2848 line argument "-q".
2849
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002850zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002851 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002852 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2853 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2854 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2855 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2856 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2857
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028593.4. Userlists
2860--------------
2861It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2862http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2863it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2864
2865userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002866 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002867 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2868
2869group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002870 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002871 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2872 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2873
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002874user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2875 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2877 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002878 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2879 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2880 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2881 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002882
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002883 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2884 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2885 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2886 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2887 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2888 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2889 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002890 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002892
2893 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002894 userlist L1
2895 group G1 users tiger,scott
2896 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002897
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002898 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2899 user scott insecure-password elgato
2900 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002901
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L2
2903 group G1
2904 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
2910 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002912
29133.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002914----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002915It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002916several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002917instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2918values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2919automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2920In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2921using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2922tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2923reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2924Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2925that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2926each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
2928peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002929 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002930 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2931
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002932bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2933 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2934 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2935
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002936disabled
2937 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2938 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2939 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2940
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002941default-bind [param*]
2942 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2943
2944default-server [param*]
2945 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2946
2947 Arguments:
2948 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2949 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2950 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2951 details.
2952
2953
2954 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2955
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002956enable
2957 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2958
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002959log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002960 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2961 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2962 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2963 more details.
2964
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002965peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002966 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2967 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002968 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002969 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002970 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2971 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2972 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2975 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2976
2977 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2979 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2980 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002982 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2983 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002984
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002985 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2986 "server" keyword explanation below).
2987
2988server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002989 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002990 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2991 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2992 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2993 of this "peers" section).
2994 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2995
2996
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002997 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003000 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3001 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3002 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003003
3004 backend mybackend
3005 mode tcp
3006 balance roundrobin
3007 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3008 stick on src
3009
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003010 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3011 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013 Example:
3014 peers mypeers
3015 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3016 default-server ssl verify none
3017 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3018 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003019
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003020
3021table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3022 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3023
3024 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3025 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003026 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003027 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3028 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3029 "stick-table" keyword).
3030
3031 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3032 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3033 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3034 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3035 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3036 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3037 of the stick-table name as follows:
3038
3039 peers mypeers
3040 peer A ...
3041 peer B ...
3042 table t1 ...
3043
3044 frontend fe1
3045 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3046
3047 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3048 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3049
3050 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3051 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3052 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3053 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3054 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3055 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3056 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3057
3058 peers mypeers
3059 peer A ...
3060 peer B ...
3061 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3062
3063 backend t1
3064 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3065
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003066 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003067 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3068 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3069
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030703.6. Mailers
3071------------
3072It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3073If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3074in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3075
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003076mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003077 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3078 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3079
3080mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3081 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3082
3083 Example:
3084 mailers mymailers
3085 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3086 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3087
3088 backend mybackend
3089 mode tcp
3090 balance roundrobin
3091
3092 email-alert mailers mymailers
3093 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3094 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3095
3096 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3097 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3098
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003099timeout mail <time>
3100 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3101 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3102 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3103 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3104
3105 Example:
3106 mailers mymailers
3107 timeout mail 20s
3108 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003109
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031103.7. Programs
3111-------------
3112In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3113master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3114managed the same way as the workers.
3115
3116During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3117sequence as a worker:
3118
3119 - the master is re-executed
3120 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3121 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3122 instance of the program
3123
3124During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3125
3126program <name>
3127 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3128 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3129 the management guide).
3130
3131command <command> [arguments*]
3132 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3133 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3134 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3135 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3136
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003137user <user name>
3138 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3139 See also "group".
3140
3141group <group name>
3142 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3143 See also "user".
3144
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003145option start-on-reload
3146no option start-on-reload
3147 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3148 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3149 program section.
3150
3151
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031523.8. HTTP-errors
3153----------------
3154
3155It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3156imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3157several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3158
3159http-errors <name>
3160 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3161 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3162
3163errorfile <code> <file>
3164 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3165
3166 Arguments :
3167 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003168 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003169 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003170
3171 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3172 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3173 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3174 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3175 before any chroot is performed.
3176
3177 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3178
3179 Example:
3180 http-errors website-1
3181 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3182 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3183 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3184
3185 http-errors website-2
3186 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3187 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3188 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3189
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031903.9. Rings
3191----------
3192
3193It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3194servers or traces.
3195
3196ring <ringname>
3197 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3198
3199description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003200 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003201 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3202
3203format <format>
3204 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3205
3206 Arguments:
3207 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3208 one of the following :
3209
3210 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3211 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3212 designed to be used with a local log server.
3213
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003214 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3215 field is stripped. This is the default.
3216 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3217 rfc3164.
3218
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003219 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3220 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3221 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3222 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3223 is the default.
3224
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003225 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003226 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3227
3228 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3229 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3230
3231 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3232 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3233 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3234 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3235 logger consumes.
3236
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003237 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3238 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3239 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3240 with a local log server.
3241
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003242 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3243 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3244 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3245 used with a local log server.
3246
3247maxlen <length>
3248 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3249 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3250 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3251
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003252server <name> <address> [param*]
3253 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3254 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3255 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3256 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3257 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3258 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3259 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3260 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3261 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003262 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3263 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003264
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003265size <size>
3266 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3267 set to BUFSIZE.
3268
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003269timeout connect <timeout>
3270 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3271
3272 Arguments :
3273 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3274 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3275 as explained at the top of this document.
3276
3277timeout server <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003285 Example:
3286 global
3287 log ring@myring local7
3288
3289 ring myring
3290 description "My local buffer"
3291 format rfc3164
3292 maxlen 1200
3293 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003294 timeout connect 5s
3295 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003296 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003297
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032983.10. Log forwarding
3299-------------------
3300
3301It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003302HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003303
3304log-forward <name>
3305 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3306
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003307backlog <conns>
3308 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3309 on connections accept.
3310
3311bind <addr> [param*]
3312 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003313 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3314 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3315 syslog protocol over TCP.
3316 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003317 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3318
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003319dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003320 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3321 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3322 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3323 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003324 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003325
3326log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003327log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003328 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3329 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3330 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003331 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003332 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3333 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3334 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003335 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336
3337 Example:
3338 global
3339 log stderr format iso local7
3340
3341 ring myring
3342 description "My local buffer"
3343 format rfc5424
3344 maxlen 1200
3345 size 32764
3346 timeout connect 5s
3347 timeout server 10s
3348 # syslog tcp server
3349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3350
3351 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003352 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3353 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003354 # all messages on stderr
3355 log global
3356 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3357 log ring@myring local0
3358 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3359 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3360 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3361 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3362 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003363
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003364maxconn <conns>
3365 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3366 10 is the default.
3367
3368timeout client <timeout>
3369 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033714. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003372----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003374Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003375 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3376 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3377 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3378 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003379
3380A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3381connections.
3382
3383A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3384to forward incoming connections.
3385
3386A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3387parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3388
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003389A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3390ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3391sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3392the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3393explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3394from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3395"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3396for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3397to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3398optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3399are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3400any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3401names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3402that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3403duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3404names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3405
3406Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3407settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3408of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3409profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3410timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3413'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3414case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3415
3416Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3417logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3418proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3419However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3420name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3421
3422Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3423and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003424bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3426modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3427arbitrary criteria.
3428
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003429In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3430a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003431the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003432
3433 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3434 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3435 between responses and new requests.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3438 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3439 client-facing connection remains open.
3440
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003441 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3442 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003443
3444The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3445frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3446following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003447weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003451 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3452 ----+-----+-----+----
3453 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3454 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3456 ----+-----+-----+----
3457 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003459It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003460only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3461within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003462as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003463content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003464and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3465possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003469processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003470second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003471protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3472is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3473new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003474to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3476already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3477HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3478evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3479one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3480
3481There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3482performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3483tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3484preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3485analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3486HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3487header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3488mitigate this drawback.
3489
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003490There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003491method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3492set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3493in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3494is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3495to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3496above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3497to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3498"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3499frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3500frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3501as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3502upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3503on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3504the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3505upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3506frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3507remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3510--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003512The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3513limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3514they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3515limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003516marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003517option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003518and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3519with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3520specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003523 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3524------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3525acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003526backlog X X X -
3527balance X - X X
3528bind - X X -
3529bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003530capture cookie - X X -
3531capture request header - X X -
3532capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003533clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3534clitcpka-idle X X X -
3535clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003536compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003537cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003538declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539default-server X - X X
3540default_backend X X X -
3541description - X X X
3542disabled X X X X
3543dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003544email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003545email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003546email-alert mailers X X X X
3547email-alert myhostname X X X X
3548email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003549enabled X X X X
3550errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003551errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003552errorloc X X X X
3553errorloc302 X X X X
3554-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3555errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003556force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003557filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003558fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003560http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003561http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003562http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003564http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003565http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003566http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003567http-check set-var X - X X
3568http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003569http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003571http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003572http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003573http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003575ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003576load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003577log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003578log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003579log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003580log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003581max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582maxconn X X X -
3583mode X X X X
3584monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585monitor-uri X X X -
3586option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3587option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3588option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3589option allbackups (*) X - X X
3590option checkcache (*) X - X X
3591option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3592option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003593option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3595option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3597option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003598option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003600option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003601option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003602option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003603option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003604option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3606option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3607option httpchk X - X X
3608option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003609option httplog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003610option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003611option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003612option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3614option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3615option logasap (*) X X X -
3616option mysql-check X - X X
3617option nolinger (*) X X X X
3618option originalto X X X X
3619option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003620option pgsql-check X - X X
3621option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003623option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624option smtpchk X - X X
3625option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3626option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3627option splice-request (*) X X X X
3628option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003629option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003630option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3631option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3632-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003633option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3635option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3636option tcpka X X X X
3637option tcplog X X X X
3638option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003639external-check command X - X X
3640external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3642rate-limit sessions X X X -
3643redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003646retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003647server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003648server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003649server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003651srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3652srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3653srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003654stats admin - X X X
3655stats auth X X X X
3656stats enable X X X X
3657stats hide-version X X X X
3658stats http-request - X X X
3659stats realm X X X X
3660stats refresh X X X X
3661stats scope X X X X
3662stats show-desc X X X X
3663stats show-legends X X X X
3664stats show-node X X X X
3665stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003666-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3667stick match - - X X
3668stick on - - X X
3669stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003670stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003671stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003672tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003673tcp-check connect X - X X
3674tcp-check expect X - X X
3675tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003676tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003677tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003678tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003679tcp-check set-var X - X X
3680tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003681tcp-request connection - X X -
3682tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003683tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003684tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003685tcp-response content - - X X
3686tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687timeout check X - X X
3688timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003689timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3692timeout http-request X X X X
3693timeout queue X - X X
3694timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003695timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003697timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003699unique-id-format X X X -
3700unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003702use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003703use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3705 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3709---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003710
3711This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3712
3713
3714acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3715 Declare or complete an access list.
3716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 no | yes | yes | yes
3718 Example:
3719 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3720 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3721 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003723 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003724
3725
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003726backlog <conns>
3727 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | no
3730 Arguments :
3731 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3732 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003733 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003734
3735 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3736 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3737 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3738 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3739 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3740 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3741 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3742 backlog parameter.
3743
3744 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3745 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3746 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3747
3748 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3749
3750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003751balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003752balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3755 yes | no | yes | yes
3756 Arguments :
3757 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3758 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3759 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3760 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3761
3762 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3763 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3764 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3765 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003766 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003767 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003768 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3769 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3770 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3771 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3772 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3773 it, so that you don't worry.
3774
3775 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3776 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3777 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3778 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3779 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3780 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3781 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3782 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003783
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003784 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3785 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3786 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3787 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3788 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3789 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3790 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003791 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3792 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3793 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003794
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003795 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003796 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003797 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3798 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003799 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003800 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3801 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3802 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3803 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3804 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003805 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3806 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3807 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3808 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3809 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3810 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003812 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3813 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3814 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3815 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3816 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3817 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3818 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3819 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003820 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003822 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3823 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3824 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003826 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3827 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3828 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3829 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3830 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3831 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3832 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3833 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3834 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3835 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3836 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3837 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003838
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003839 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003840 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3841 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3842 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3843 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3844 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3845 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3846 URIs start with a leading "/".
3847
3848 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3849 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3850 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3851 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3852
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003853 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3854 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3855 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3856 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003859 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3860
3861 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003862 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3863 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003864 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3865 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3866 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3867 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003868 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003869 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3870 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003871
3872 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3873 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3874 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3875 server will receive the request.
3876
3877 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3878 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3879 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3880 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3881 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003882 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3883 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3884 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003885
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003886 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3887 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3888 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3889 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3890 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003892 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003893 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3894 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3895 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3896
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003897 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3898 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3899 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3900
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003901 random
3902 random(<draws>)
3903 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003904 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3905 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3906 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3907 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003908 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3909 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3910 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3911 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3912 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3913 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3914 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3915 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3916 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3917 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3918 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3919 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3920 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3921 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3922 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3923 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3924 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3925 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3926 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3927 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003928
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003929 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003930 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003931 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3932 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3933 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3934 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3935 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3936 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003937 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003938 used instead.
3939
3940 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3941 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3942 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3943 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3944
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003945 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3946 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3947 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3948
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003949 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003951 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003952 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3953 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003954
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003955 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3956 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3957 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003958
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003959 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003960 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003961 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3962 NTLM relies on.
3963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003964 Examples :
3965 balance roundrobin
3966 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003967 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003968 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3969 balance hdr(host)
3970 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003971
3972 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3973 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003975 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003976 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3977 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3978 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003979 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003980
3981 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3982 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3983 defaults to 16 kB.
3984
3985 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3986 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3987
3988 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3989 Round Robin.
3990
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003991 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003992 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3993 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3994 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3995
3996 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3997
3998 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003999 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004000 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4001 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4002 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004003
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004004 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005
4006
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004007bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4008bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 no | yes | yes | no
4012 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004013 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4014 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4015 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4016 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004017 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004018 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4019 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4020 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4021 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4022 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4023 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004024 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004025 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4026 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004027 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004028 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4029 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004030 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004031 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4032 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004033 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004034 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004035 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4036 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4037 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004038 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4039 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4040 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4041 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004042 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4043 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4044 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004045
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004046 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4047 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004048 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4049 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4050 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004051 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4052 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4053 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4054 the range.
4055
4056 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4057 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4058 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4059 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4060 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4061 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4062 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004063 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004064 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004065
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004066 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004067 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004068 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4069 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4070 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4071 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4072 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4073 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004075 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4076 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4077 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4078 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4081 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4082 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4083 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4084 in a frontend.
4085
4086 Example :
4087 listen http_proxy
4088 bind :80,:443
4089 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004090 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004092 listen http_https_proxy
4093 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004094 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004095
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004096 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4097 bind ipv6@:80
4098 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4099 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4100
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004101 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004102 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004103
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004104 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4105 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4106 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4107 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4108 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4109
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004110 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004111 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004112
4113
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004114bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004117
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004118 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4119 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4120 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4121 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4122 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4123 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004124
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004125 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004126
4127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128capture cookie <name> len <length>
4129 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4131 no | yes | yes | no
4132 Arguments :
4133 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4134 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4135 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4136 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004137 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138
4139 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4140 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4141 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4142 right if it exceeds <length>.
4143
4144 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4145 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4146 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4147 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4148
4149 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4150 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4151 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4152
4153 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4154 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4155 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004156 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4157 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4158 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004159
4160 Example:
4161 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4162
4163 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004164 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004165
4166
4167capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 no | yes | yes | no
4171 Arguments :
4172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004174 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4177
4178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4180 it exceeds <length>.
4181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004183 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4184 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004185 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4186 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4187 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4188 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004189 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004190 environments to find where the request came from.
4191
4192 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4193 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4194 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4195 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004196
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004197 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4198 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4199 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4200 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4201 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004202
4203 Example:
4204 capture request header Host len 15
4205 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004206 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004208 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209 about logging.
4210
4211
4212capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004213 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 no | yes | yes | no
4216 Arguments :
4217 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004218 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4220 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4221 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4222
4223 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4224 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4225 it exceeds <length>.
4226
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004227 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4229 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4230 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004231 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4232 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4233 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4234 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004235
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004236 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4237 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4238 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4239 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4240 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241
4242 Example:
4243 capture response header Content-length len 9
4244 capture response header Location len 15
4245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004246 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004247 about logging.
4248
4249
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004250clitcpka-cnt <count>
4251 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4252 the connection on the client side.
4253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4254 yes | yes | yes | no
4255 Arguments :
4256 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4257
4258 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4259 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004260 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4261 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004262
4263 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4264
4265
4266clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4267 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4268 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4269 client side.
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 yes | yes | yes | no
4272 Arguments :
4273 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4274 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4275 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4276 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4277
4278 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4279 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004280 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4281 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004282
4283 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4284
4285
4286clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4287 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4289 yes | yes | yes | no
4290 Arguments :
4291 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4292 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4293 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4294 document.
4295
4296 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4297 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004298 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4299 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004300
4301 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4302
4303
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004304compression algo <algorithm> ...
4305compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004306compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004307 Enable HTTP compression.
4308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4309 yes | yes | yes | yes
4310 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004311 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4312 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004313 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004314
4315 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004316 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4317 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4318 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004319
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004320 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004321 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004322
4323 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4324 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4325 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4326 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4327 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004328 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004329
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004330 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4331 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4332 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4333 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4334 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4335 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4336 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004337 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004338
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004339 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004340 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004341 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004342 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004343 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004344 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004345 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004346
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004347 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004348 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4349 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004350 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4351 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004352 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004353 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004354 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4355 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004356 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004357 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4358 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004359
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004360 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004361 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4362 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004363 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004364 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004365 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4366 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4367 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4368 "multipart"
4369 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4370 header
4371 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4372 and later
4373 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4374 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004375 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004376
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004377 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004378
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004379 Examples :
4380 compression algo gzip
4381 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004382
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004384cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004385 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4386 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004387 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004388 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4390 yes | no | yes | yes
4391 Arguments :
4392 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4393 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4394 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4395 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4396 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4397 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004398 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004399 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4400 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4401
4402 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004403 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004404 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4405 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4406 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4407 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004408 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4409 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004410 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004411 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4412 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
4414 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004415 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004416
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004417 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004418 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004419 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004420 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004421 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4422 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4423 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4424 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4425 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4426 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4427 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004428
4429 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4430 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4431 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4432 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4433 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4434 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4435 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4436 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4437 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004438 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004439 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4440 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4441 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004443 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4444 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4445 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004446 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4447 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4448 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4449 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004450 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4451 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4452 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004453
4454 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4455 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4456 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4457 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4458 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4459 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4460 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4461 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4462 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4463
4464 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4465 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4466 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4467 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4468 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4469 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4470 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4471 persistence cookie in the cache.
4472 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4473
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004474 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4475 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004476 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004477 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4478 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004479 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004480 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4481 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4482 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4483 they logout.
4484
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004485 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004486 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4487 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4488 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4489
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004490 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004491 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4492 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4493 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4494 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4495 this attribute.
4496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004497 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004498 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004499 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4500 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4501 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4502 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4503 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4504 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004505
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004506 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4507 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4508 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4509 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4510 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4511 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4512 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4513 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004514 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004515 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4516 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4517 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4518 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4519 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4520 the site.
4521
4522 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4523 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4524 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4525 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4526 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4527 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4528 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4529 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4530 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4531 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4532 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4533 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4534 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004535 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004536 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4537 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4538
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004539 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4540 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4541 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4542 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4543 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4544 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4545
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004546 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004547 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4548 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4549 repeated.
4550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004551 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4552 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4553 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4554 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004556 Examples :
4557 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4558 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4559 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004560 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004562 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004564
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004565declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4566 Declares a capture slot.
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 no | yes | yes | no
4569 Arguments:
4570 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4571
4572 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4573 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4574 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4575 for use in the response.
4576
4577 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004578 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004579 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4580
4581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004582default-server [param*]
4583 Change default options for a server in a backend
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 yes | no | yes | yes
4586 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004587 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4588 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4589 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4590 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004591
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004592 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004593 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4594
4595 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004596
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004598default_backend <backend>
4599 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4601 yes | yes | yes | no
4602 Arguments :
4603 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4604
4605 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4606 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4607 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4608 will catch all undetermined requests.
4609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004610 Example :
4611
4612 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4613 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4614 default_backend dynamic
4615
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004616 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004618
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004619description <string>
4620 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 no | yes | yes | yes
4623 Arguments : string
4624
4625 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4626 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4627 it describes.
4628 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4629
4630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004631disabled
4632 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 yes | yes | yes | yes
4635 Arguments : none
4636
4637 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4638 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4639 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4640 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4641 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4642 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4643 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4644
4645 See also : "enabled"
4646
4647
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004648dispatch <address>:<port>
4649 Set a default server address
4650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004652 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004653
4654 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4655 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4656 during start-up.
4657
4658 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4659 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4660 possible with normal servers.
4661
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004662 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004663 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4664 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4665 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4666 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4667
4668 See also : "server"
4669
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004670
4671dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4672 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4674 yes | no | yes | yes
4675 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4676
4677 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004678 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004679 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4680 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004681 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004682 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004684enabled
4685 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 yes | yes | yes | yes
4688 Arguments : none
4689
4690 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4691 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4692
4693 See also : "disabled"
4694
4695
4696errorfile <code> <file>
4697 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 yes | yes | yes | yes
4700 Arguments :
4701 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004702 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004703 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004704
4705 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004706 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004707 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004708 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4709 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004710
4711 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4712 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4713 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4714
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004715 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4716
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004717 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4718 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4719 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4720 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4721 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4722 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4723 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4724 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4725 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004727 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4728 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4729 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004730 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4732
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004733 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004735 Example :
4736 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004737 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004738 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4739 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4740
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004741
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004742errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4743 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4744 section.
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | yes
4747 Arguments :
4748 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4749
4750 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004751 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004752 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4753 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004754
4755 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4756 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4757 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4758 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4759 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004760 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004761 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4762
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004763 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4764 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004765
4766 Example :
4767 errorfiles generic
4768 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4769
4770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004771errorloc <code> <url>
4772errorloc302 <code> <url>
4773 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | yes | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004778 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004779 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004780
4781 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4782 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4783 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4784 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004785 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004786
4787 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4788 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4789 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4790
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004791 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004793 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4794 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4795 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4796 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004797 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004798 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4799 request.
4800
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004801 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004802
4803
4804errorloc303 <code> <url>
4805 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004810 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004811 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812
4813 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4814 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4815 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4816 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004817 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004818
4819 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4820 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4821 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4822
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004823 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4824
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004825 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4826 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4827 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4828 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004829 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004831 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
4833
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004834email-alert from <emailaddr>
4835 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004836 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | yes | yes | yes
4839
4840 Arguments :
4841
4842 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4843
4844 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4845 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4846
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004847 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004848 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4849 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004850
4851
4852email-alert level <level>
4853 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4854 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | yes | yes | yes
4857
4858 Arguments :
4859
4860 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4861 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4862 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4863
4864 By default level is alert
4865
4866 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4867 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4868 for the proxy.
4869
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004870 Alerts are sent when :
4871
4872 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4873 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4874 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4875 is notice or lower
4876 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4877 and a health check status update occurs
4878
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004879 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4880 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004881 section 3.6 about mailers.
4882
4883
4884email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4885 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | yes | yes | yes
4888
4889 Arguments :
4890
4891 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4892
4893 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4894 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4895
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004896 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4897 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004898
4899
4900email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4901 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4902 mailers.
4903 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | yes | yes | yes
4905
4906 Arguments :
4907
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004908 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004909
4910 By default the systems hostname is used.
4911
4912 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4913 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4914 for the proxy.
4915
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004916 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4917 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004918
4919
4920email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004921 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004922 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | yes | yes | yes
4925
4926 Arguments :
4927
4928 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4929
4930 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4931 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4932
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004933 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004934 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4935
4936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004937force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4938 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004940 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004941
4942 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4943 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4944 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4945 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4946 marked down for maintenance operations.
4947
4948 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4949 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4950 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4951 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4952 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4953 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4954 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4955 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4956 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4957
4958 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4959 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4960 is used.
4961
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004962 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004963 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004964
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004965
4966filter <name> [param*]
4967 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 no | yes | yes | yes
4970 Arguments :
4971 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4972 referenced in section 9.
4973
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004974 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004975 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004976 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4977 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004978
4979 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4980 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4981
4982 Example:
4983 listen
4984 bind *:80
4985
4986 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4987 filter compression
4988 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4989
4990 compression algo gzip
4991 compression offload
4992
4993 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4994
4995 See also : section 9.
4996
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004997
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004998fullconn <conns>
4999 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | no | yes | yes
5002 Arguments :
5003 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5004 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5005
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005006 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005007 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005008 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005009 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5010 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5011 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5012 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5013 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005014 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005015
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005016 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005017 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005018 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5019 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5020 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005021
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022 Example :
5023 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5024 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5025 # connections.
5026 backend dynamic
5027 fullconn 10000
5028 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5029 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5030
5031 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5032
5033
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005034hash-balance-factor <factor>
5035 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | no | no | yes
5038 Arguments :
5039 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5040 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005041 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005042
5043 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5044 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5045 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5046 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5047 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5048 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5049 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5050
5051 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5052 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5053 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5054 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5055 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5056
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005057 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5058 consistent hashing mechanism.
5059
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005060 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5061
5062
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005063hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005064 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | no | yes | yes
5067 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005068 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5069 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005070
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005071 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5072 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5073 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5074 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5075 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5076 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5077 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5078 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5079 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5080 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005081
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005082 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5083 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5084 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5085 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5086 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5087 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5088 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5089 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5090 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5091 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5092 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5093 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5094 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005095 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5096 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005097
5098 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5099
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005100 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005101 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5102 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5103 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005104 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5105 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5106 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005107
5108 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5109 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005110 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5111 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5112 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5113 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5114
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005115 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005116 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5117 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5118 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5119 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5120 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5121 parameter.
5122
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005123 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5124 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5125 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5126 used on strings.
5127
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005128 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5129
5130 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5131 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5132 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5133 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5134 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5135 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5136 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5137 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5138 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5139 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5140 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5141 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005142
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005143 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5144 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5145 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005146
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005147 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005148
5149
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005150http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5151 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5152 ones).
5153
5154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 no | yes | yes | yes
5156
5157 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5158 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5159 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5160 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5161 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5162 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5163
5164 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5165 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5166 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5167
5168 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5169 below.
5170
5171 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5172 instance.
5173
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005174 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5175 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5176 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5177
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005178 Example:
5179 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5180 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5181 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5182
5183http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184
5185 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5186 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5187 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5188 example, or to pass some internal information.
5189 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5190 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5191 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5192
5193http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5194
5195 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5196 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5197
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005198http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005199
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005200 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5201 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5202 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5203 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5204 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005205
5206http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5207 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5208
5209 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5210
5211 Example:
5212 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5213
5214 # applied to:
5215 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5216
5217 # outputs:
5218 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5219
5220 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5221
5222http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5223 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5226
5227 Example:
5228 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5229
5230 # applied to:
5231 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5232
5233 # outputs:
5234 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5235
5236http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5237
5238 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5239 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5240 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5241
5242http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5243 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5244
5245 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5246 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5247 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5248 fallback.
5249
5250 Example:
5251 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5252 http-response set-status 431
5253 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5254 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5255
5256http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5257
5258 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5259 inline.
5260
5261 Arguments:
5262 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5263 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5266 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5267 (request and response)
5268 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5269 processing
5270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5271 processing
5272 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5273 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5274 and '_'.
5275
5276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5277 followed by some converters.
5278
5279 Example:
5280 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5281
5282http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5283
5284 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5285 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5286 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5287 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5288 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005289 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005290 processing.
5291
5292 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5293 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005294 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005295 rules evaluation.
5296
5297http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5298
5299 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5300 details about <var-name>.
5301
5302 Example:
5303 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5304
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005305
5306http-check comment <string>
5307 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5308 it fails.
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 yes | no | yes | yes
5311
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005312 Arguments :
5313 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5314 rule fails.
5315
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005316 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5317 user-friendly error reporting.
5318
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005319 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005320 "http-check expect".
5321
5322
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005323http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5324 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005325 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005326 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005330 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005331 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5332
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005333 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005334 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005335
5336 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5337 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5338 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5339 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5340
5341 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5342
5343 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5344
5345 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5346
5347 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5348
5349 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5350
5351 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5352 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5353 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5354 is used.
5355
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005356 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5357 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5358 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5359 haproxy -vv.
5360
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5362
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005363 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5364 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5365 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5366 different ports or with different servers.
5367
5368 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5369 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5370 the port with a "http-check connect".
5371
5372 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5373 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5374 do.
5375
5376 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5377 unset-var or comment rules.
5378
5379 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005380 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5381 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5382 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5383 option httpchk
5384
5385 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005386 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005387 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005388 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005389 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005390 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005391
5392 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5393
5394 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005395
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005397http-check disable-on-404
5398 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005400 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005401 Arguments : none
5402
5403 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5404 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5405 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5406 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5407 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5408 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5409 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5410 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005411 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5412 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005413 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5414 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5415 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005416
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005417 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005418
5419
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005420http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005421 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5422 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5423 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005424 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005426 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005427
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005428 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005429 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5430
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005431 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5432 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5433 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5434 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5435 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5436 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5437 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5438 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5439 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5440 result is always conclusive.
5441
5442 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5443 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5444 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005445 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5446 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005447 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5448 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005449 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5450 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5451 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005452
5453 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5454 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005455 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5456 supported :
5457 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5458 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005459 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5460 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5461 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5462 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5463 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005464
5465 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5466 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005467 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5468 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5469 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5470 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5472
5473 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5474 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5475 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5476 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5477
5478 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5479 informational message reported in logs if an error
5480 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5481 log-format string.
5482
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005483 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005484 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5485 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005486 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5487 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5488 details on the supported keywords.
5489
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005490 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5491 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5492 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5493 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005494
5495 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5496 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5497 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5498 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5499 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5500
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005501 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5502 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5503 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5504 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5505 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5506 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5507 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005508
5509 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005510 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005511 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5512 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5513 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5514 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5515
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005516 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5517 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005518 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5519 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5520 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5521 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5522 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5523 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5524 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5525 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005526 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5527 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5528 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5529 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5530 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5531 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5532 insensitive on the header names.
5533
5534 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5535 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5536 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5537 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5538 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5539 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005540
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005541 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5544 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5545 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5546 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5547 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005548 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005549 trace).
5550
5551 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005552 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005553 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5554 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5555 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5556 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5557 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005558 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005559
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005560 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5561 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5562 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5563 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5564 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5565 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5566
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005567 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005568 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5570 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5571 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5572 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5573 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5574 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5575
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005576 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5577 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5578 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5579 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5580 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005581
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005582 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5583 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5584
5585 Examples :
5586 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005587 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005588
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005589 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5590 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5591
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005592 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005593 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005594
5595 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005596 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597
5598 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005599 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005600
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005601 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005602 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005603
5604
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005605http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005606 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5607 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005608 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5609 health checks.
5610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5611 yes | no | yes | yes
5612 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005613 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5614
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005615 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5616 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5617 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5618 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5619 to invent non-standard ones.
5620
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005621 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5622 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5623 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5624 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5625
5626 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5627 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5628 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5629 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005630
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005631 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005632 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005633 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005634 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5635 to add it.
5636
5637 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5638 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5639 to the log-format rules.
5640
5641 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5642 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5643 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005644
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005645 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5646 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5647 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5648 request.
5649
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005650 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5651 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5652 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005653 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5654 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5655 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5656 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005657 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005658
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005659 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005660 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5661 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005662
5663 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5664 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5665 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5666 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5667 configured request authority.
5668
5669 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5670 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005672 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005673
5674
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005675http-check send-state
5676 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | no | yes | yes
5679 Arguments : none
5680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005681 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005682 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005683 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5684 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5685 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005686
5687 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5688 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5689 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5690 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5691 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005692 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5693 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5694 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5695
5696 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5697 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5698 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5699
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005700 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5701 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5702 checked in multiple backends.
5703
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005704 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005705 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5706
5707 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5708 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5709 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5710 one fails.
5711
5712 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5713 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5714 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5715
5716 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5717 server's queue.
5718
5719 Example of a header received by the application server :
5720 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5721 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5722
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005723 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5724 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005725
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005726
5727http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | no | yes | yes
5731
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005732 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5734 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5737 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5738 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5739 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5740 and '-'.
5741
5742 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005744 Examples :
5745 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005746
5747
5748http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005749 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | no | yes | yes
5752
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005753 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005754 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5755 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5758 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5759 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5760 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5761 and '-'.
5762
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005763 Examples :
5764 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005767http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5768 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5769 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5770 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5771 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5773 yes | yes | yes | yes
5774 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005775 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005776 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005777 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005778 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005779
5780 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5781 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5782 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5783 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5784
5785 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5786 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5787 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5788 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5789
5790 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5791 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5792 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5793 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5794 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5795 chroot is performed.
5796
5797 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5798 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5799 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5800 considered.
5801
5802 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5803 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5804 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5805 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5806 considered as a raw string.
5807
5808 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5809 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5810 "content-type".
5811
5812 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5813 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5814 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5815 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5816 evaluated as a log-format string.
5817
5818 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5819 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5820 argument to "content-type".
5821
5822 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5823 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5824 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5825 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5826
5827 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5828 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5829 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5830 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5831 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5832 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5833 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5834 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5835
5836 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5837 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5838 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5839
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005840 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5841 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5842 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5843 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5844 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005846 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5847 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5848
5849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005851 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5852
5853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5854 no | yes | yes | yes
5855
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005856 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5857 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5858 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5859 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5860 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5863 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005864
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005865 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005867 Example:
5868 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5869 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5870 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872 http-request allow if nagios
5873 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5874 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5875 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005877 Example:
5878 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5879 acl add path /addacl
5880 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005882 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5885 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887 Example:
5888 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5889 acl setmap path /setmap
5890 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5895 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005897 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5898 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005900http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005902 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5903 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5904 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5905 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5906 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5907 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5908 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5909 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005913 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5914 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5915 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5916 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5917 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5918 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5919 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5920 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5925 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005926
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5931 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5932 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5933 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5934 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005935
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005936 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5937 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5938 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5939 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5940 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5941 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5942 instead.
5943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005944 Example:
5945 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5946 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005947
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005948http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005950 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5953 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5956 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5957 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5958 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5959 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5960 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5961 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5962 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5963 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5966 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5967 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005968 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5969
5970 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5971 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5972 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5973 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005977 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5978 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5979 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5980 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5981 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5982 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005983
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005984http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005985
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005986 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5987 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5988 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5989 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5990 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005992http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5995 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5996 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5997 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5998 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5999 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006000
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006001http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6002http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6003 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6004 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6005 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6006 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006007
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006008 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6009 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6010 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006011 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006012 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6013 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6014 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006015 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006016 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006017
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006018http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6019 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6020 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6021 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6022
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006023http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6024
6025 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6026 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6027 pointed by <resolvers>.
6028 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6029 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6030 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6031 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6032 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6033 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6034 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6035 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6036 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6037 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6038 to 0.0.0.0.
6039
6040 Example:
6041 resolvers mydns
6042 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6043 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6044 timeout retry 1s
6045 hold valid 10s
6046 hold nx 3s
6047 hold other 3s
6048 hold obsolete 0s
6049 accepted_payload_size 8192
6050
6051 frontend fe
6052 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6053 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6054 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6055
6056 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6057 # which mean DNS resolution error
6058 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6059
6060 default_backend be
6061
6062 backend b_503
6063 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6064 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6065 # 503 error page to end users
6066
6067 backend be
6068 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6069 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6070 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6071 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6072 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6073
6074 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6075 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6076
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006077http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6078
6079 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6080 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6081 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6082 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006083 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6084 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006085
6086 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6087
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006088http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006089http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006090http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006091http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006092http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006093http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006094http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006095http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6096http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006097
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006098 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6099
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006100 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006101 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6102 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6103 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6104 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006105
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006106 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6107 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6108 the supported backend.
6109
6110 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6111 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6112 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6113 number of segments in the path.
6114
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006115 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6116 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6117 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6118 when improperly combined.
6119
6120 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6121 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6122 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6123 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6124 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6125
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006126 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006127
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006128 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6129
6130 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6131 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6132
6133 Example:
6134 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6135
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006136 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6137
6138 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6139 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6140
6141 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6142 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6143
6144 Example:
6145 - /#foo -> /
6146
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006147 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6148 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006149
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006150 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6151 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6152
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006153 Example:
6154 - /. -> /
6155 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6156 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6157 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006158
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006159 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6160 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6161
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006162 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006163 their preceding segment.
6164
6165 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6166 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6167
6168 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6169 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006170
6171 Example:
6172 - /foo/../ -> /
6173 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6174 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6175 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006176 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006177 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006178 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006179
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006180 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6181 removed as well:
6182
6183 Example:
6184 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6185 - /bar/../../ -> /
6186
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006187 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6188 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006189
6190 Example:
6191 - // -> /
6192 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6193
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006194 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6195 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6196
6197 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6198 ".", "_", and "~".
6199
6200 Example:
6201 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6202 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6203 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6204 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6205
6206 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6207 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6208
6209 Example:
6210 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6211 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6212
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006213 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006214 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006215
6216 Example:
6217 - /%6f -> /%6F
6218 - /%zz -> /%zz
6219
6220 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6221 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6222
6223 Example:
6224 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6225
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006226 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006227 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6228 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6229
6230 Example:
6231 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6232 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6233 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006235http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006237 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6238 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6239 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6240 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6241 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006243http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006245 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6246 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6247 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6248 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006250http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006252
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006253 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006254 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6255 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6256 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6257 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6258 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006259
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006260 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6261 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6262 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6263 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6264 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006265
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006266 Example:
6267 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6268
6269 # applied to:
6270 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6271
6272 # outputs:
6273 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6274
6275 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006276
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006277 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6278
6279 # applied to:
6280 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006281
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006282 # outputs:
6283 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006284
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006285http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6286 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6287
6288 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6289 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006290 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6291 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6292 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006293
6294 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6295 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6296 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6297
6298 Example:
6299 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6300 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6301
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006302 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6303 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6304 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6305 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6306
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006307http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6308 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6309
6310 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6311 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6312 query-string are replaced.
6313
6314 Example:
6315 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6316 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6317
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006318http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6319 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6320
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006321 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6322 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6323 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6324 against.
6325
6326 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6327 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6328 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006329
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006330 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6331 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6332 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6333 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6334 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6335 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6336 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6337 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6338 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006339 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6340 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006341
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006342 Example:
6343 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6344 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006345
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006346 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6347 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006349http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6350 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006351
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006352 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6353 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6354 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6355 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006356
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006357 Example:
6358 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006359
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006360 # applied to:
6361 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006362
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006363 # outputs:
6364 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006365
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006366http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6367 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6368 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006369 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6371
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006372 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006373 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6374 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006375 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006376 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006377 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006378 are followed to create the response :
6379
6380 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6381 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6382 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6383 ignored.
6384
6385 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6386 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006387 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006388 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6389 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006390
6391 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6392 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6393 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006394 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006395 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006396
6397 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6398 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6399 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006400 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006401 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006402 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006403
6404 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6405 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6406 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6407 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6408 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6409 as a raw content.
6410
6411 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6412 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6413 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6414 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6415 considered as a raw string.
6416
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006417 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006418 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6419 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6420 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6421
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006422 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6423 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006424 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006425
6426 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6427
6428 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006429 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006430 if { path /ping }
6431
6432 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6433 if { path /favicon.ico }
6434
6435 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6436 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6437 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6438
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006439http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6440
6441 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6442 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6443 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6444 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6445 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6446 at this index.
6447 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6448 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006450http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6451http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006453 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6454 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6455 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006456
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006457http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6458 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6459 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6460 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6461 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6462 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6463 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6464 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6465 at this index.
6466 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6467 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6468
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006469http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6470 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006471
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006472 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6473 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6474 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6475 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006477http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006479 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6480 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6481 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6482 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6483 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006484
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006485 Arguments:
6486 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6487 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489 Example:
6490 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6491 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006493 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6494 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6499 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6500 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006502 Arguments:
6503 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6504 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006506 Example:
6507 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6508 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006510 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6511 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6512 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006514http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006516 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6517 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6518 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6519 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6520 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006522 Example:
6523 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6524 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6525 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6526 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6527 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6528 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006533http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6536 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6537 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6538 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6539 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006541http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6545 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6546 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6547 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6548 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6549 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6550 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6551 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6552 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006554http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006555
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006556 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6557 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6558 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6559 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6560 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6561 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6562 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006563 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6564 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006566http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6569 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6570 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6575 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6576 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6577 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6578 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6579 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6580 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6581 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006585 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6586 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6587 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6588 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6589 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6590 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592 Example :
6593 # prepend the host name before the path
6594 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006595
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006596http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6597
6598 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6599 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6600 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6605 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6606 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6607 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6608 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006610http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6613 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6614 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6615 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6616 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6617 values have higher priority.
6618 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6619 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6620 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6621 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6622 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6627 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6628 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6629 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6630 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6631 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6632 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006635
6636 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6638 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6641 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6642 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6643 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006644 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6645 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646
6647 Arguments :
6648 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6649 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006650
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006651 See also "option forwardfor".
6652
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006653 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6655 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6656
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006657 # After the masking this will track connections
6658 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6659 http-request track-sc0 src
6660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006661 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6662 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6663
6664http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6665
6666 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6667 expression.
6668
6669 Arguments:
6670 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6671 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006672
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006673 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6675 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6676
6677 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6678 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6679 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6680
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006681http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006682 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6683
6684 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6685 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6686 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6687 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6688 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6689
6690 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6691 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6692 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6693 results.
6694
6695 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006696 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6697 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006699http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6700
6701 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6702 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6703 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6704 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6705 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6706 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6707 information from the request.
6708
6709 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6710
6711http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6712
6713 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6714 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6715 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6716 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6717 path and the query string.
6718 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6719
6720http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6721
6722 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6723 inline.
6724
6725 Arguments:
6726 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6727 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6728 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6729 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6730 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6731 (request and response)
6732 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6733 processing
6734 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6735 processing
6736 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6737 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6738 and '_'.
6739
6740 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6741 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006742
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006743 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6747 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6750 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6751 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6752 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6753 agent name must be used.
6754
6755 Arguments:
6756 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6757
6758 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6759 configuration.
6760
6761http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6762
6763 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6764 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6765 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6766 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6767 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6768 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6769 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6770 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6771 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6772 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6773 action.
6774 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6775 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6776 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6777 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6778 you fully understand how it works.
6779
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006780http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6781
6782 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6783 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6784 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6785 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6786 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006787 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006788 processing.
6789
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006790 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006791 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6792 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6793 rules evaluation.
6794
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006795http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6796http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6797 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6798 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6799 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6800 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006801
6802 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6803 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6804 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006805 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6806 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6807 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6808 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6809 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6810 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006811 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006812 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6813 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6814 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006815 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006816 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6817 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6818 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6819 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6820 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006821
6822http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6823http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825
6826 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6827 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6828 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6829 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006830 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006831 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6832 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6833 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6834 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6835 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6836 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6837 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6838
6839 Arguments :
6840 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6841 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6842 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6843 select which table entry to update the counters.
6844
6845 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6846 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6847 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6848 that table until the session ends.
6849
6850 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6851 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6852 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6853 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6854 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6855 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6856 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6857 useful information.
6858
6859 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6860 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6861 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6862 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6863 checks that make use of it.
6864
6865http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6866
6867 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006868
6869 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006870 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006871
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006872http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6873
6874 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6875 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6876 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6877 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6878 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6879 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6880
6881 Arguments :
6882 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6883
6884 Example:
6885 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6886
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006887http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6889
6890 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6891 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6892 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6893 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6894 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6895 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6896 http-buffer-request".
6897
6898 Arguments :
6899
6900 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6901 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6902
6903 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006904 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006905 bytes.
6906
6907 Example:
6908 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6909
6910 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006912http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006914 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6915 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6916 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006917
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006919http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006920 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6921
6922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 no | yes | yes | yes
6924
6925 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6926 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6927 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6928 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6929 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6930 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006932 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6933 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006935 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006937 Example:
6938 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006940 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006942 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6943 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006945 Example:
6946 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006948 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006950 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6951 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006953 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6954 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006956http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6959 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6960 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6961 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6962 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6963 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6964 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6965 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006969 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6970 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6971 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6972 example, or to pass some internal information.
6973 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6974 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6975 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006977http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6980 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006981
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006982http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006984 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6989 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6990 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6991 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6992 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6993 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6994 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006996 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6997 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6998 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6999 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7000 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007001
7002 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7003 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7004 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7005 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007007http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7010 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7011 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7012 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7013 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7014 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007015
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007016http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007017
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007018 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7019 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7020 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7021 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7022 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007024http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007026 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7027 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7028 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7029 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7030 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7031 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007032
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007033http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7034http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7035 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7036 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7037 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7038 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007039
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007040 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7041 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7042 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007043 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007044 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7045 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7046 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007047 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007048 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7053 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7054 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7055 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7056 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7057 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007061
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007062 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7063 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 Example:
7066 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 # applied to:
7069 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 # outputs:
7072 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007074 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7077 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007078
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007079 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007080 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082 Example:
7083 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 # applied to:
7086 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007088 # outputs:
7089 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007090
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007091http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7092 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7093 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007094 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7096
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007097 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007098 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7099 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007100 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007101 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007102 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007103 are followed to create the response :
7104
7105 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7106 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7107 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7108 ignored.
7109
7110 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7111 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007112 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007113 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7114 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007115
7116 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7117 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7118 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007119 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007120 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007121
7122 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7123 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7124 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007125 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007126 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007127 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007128
7129 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7130 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7131 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7132 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7133 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7134 as a raw content.
7135
7136 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7137 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7138 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7139 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7140 considered as a raw string.
7141
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007142 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7143 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7144 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7145 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7146
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007147 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7148 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007149 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007150
7151 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7152
7153 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007154 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007155 if { status eq 404 }
7156
7157 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7158 string "This is the end !" \
7159 if { status eq 500 }
7160
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007161http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7162
7163 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7164 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7165 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7166 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7167 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7168 at this index.
7169 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7170 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7173http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007175 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7176 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7177 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007178
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007179http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7181
7182 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7183 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7184 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7185 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7186 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7187 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7188 at this index.
7189 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7190 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7191
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007192http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7193 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007194
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007195 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7196 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7197 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7198 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7203 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7204 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7205 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7206 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208 Arguments:
7209 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007211 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7212 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007214http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7217 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7218 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007220http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7221
7222 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7223 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7224 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7225 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7226 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7227
7228http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7229
7230 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7231 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7232 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7233 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7234 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7235 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7236 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7237 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7238 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7239
7240http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7241
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007242 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7243 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7244 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7245 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7246 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7247 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7248 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007249 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7250 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007251
7252http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7253
7254 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7255 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7256 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7257 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7258 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7259 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7260 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7261 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7262
7263http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7264 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7265
7266 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7267 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7268 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7269 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007270
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007271 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007272 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7273 http-response set-status 431
7274 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7275 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007277http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007279 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7280 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7281 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7282 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7283 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7284 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7285 based on some information from the request.
7286
7287 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7288
7289http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7290
7291 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7292 inline.
7293
7294 Arguments:
7295 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7296 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7300 (request and response)
7301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7302 processing
7303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7304 processing
7305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7306 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7307 and '_'.
7308
7309 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7310 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007311
7312 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007313 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7318 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7319 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7320 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7321 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7322 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7323 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7324 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7325 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7326 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7327 action.
7328 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7329 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7330 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7331 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7332 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007333
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007334http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7335
7336 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7337 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7338 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7339 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7340 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007341 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007342 processing.
7343
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007344 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007345 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007346 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007347 rules evaluation.
7348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007349http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7350http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007353 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7354 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7355 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7356 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7357 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007358 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007359
7360http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361
7362 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7363 about <var-name>.
7364
7365 Example:
7366 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7367
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007368http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7369 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7370
7371 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7372 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7373 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7374 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7375 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7376 buffer is full.
7377
7378 Arguments :
7379
7380 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7381 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7382
7383 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007384 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007385 bytes.
7386
7387 Example:
7388 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007389
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007390http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7391 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7392
7393 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7394 yes | no | yes | yes
7395
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007396 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007397 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7398 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7399 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007400
7401 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7402
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007403 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7404 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7405 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7406 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7407 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7408 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7409 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007410 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007411 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7412 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007413
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007414 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7415 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7416 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7417 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7418 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7419 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7420 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007421 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7422 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7423 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7424 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7425 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7426 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007427
7428 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7429 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7430 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7431 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7432 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7433 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7434 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7435 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007436 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007437 downsides of rare connection failures.
7438
7439 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7440 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7441 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7442 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7443 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7444 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007445 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007446 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7447 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7448 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7449 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7450 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7451
7452 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007453 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7454 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7455 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7456 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007457
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007458 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7459 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007460
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007461 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
7463 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7464 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7465 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7466
7467 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7468
7469
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007470http-send-name-header [<header>]
7471 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007474 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007475 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7476
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007477 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7478 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7479 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7480 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7481 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7482 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7483 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7484 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7485 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7486 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7487 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7488 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7489 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7490 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7491 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7492 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007493
7494 See also : "server"
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007496id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007497 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 no | yes | yes | yes
7500 Arguments : none
7501
7502 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7503 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7504 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007505
7506
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007507ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7508 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007510 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007511
7512 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7513 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7514 and running).
7515
7516 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7517 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7518 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007519 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007520 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7521
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007522 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7523 "unless" condition is met.
7524
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007525 Example:
7526 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7527 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7528 ignore-persist if url_static
7529
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007530 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7531
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007532load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7533 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536
7537 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7538 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7539 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007540 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007541 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007542 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7543 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7544 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7545
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007546 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007547 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007548 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007549
7550 Arguments:
7551 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7552 named "server-state-file".
7553
7554 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7555 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7556 name is used as a file name.
7557
7558 none don't load any stat for this backend
7559
7560 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007561 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7562 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7563 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007564 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007565 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007566
7567 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7568 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7569
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007570 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007572 global
7573 stats socket /tmp/socket
7574 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007576 defaults
7577 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007578
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007579 backend bk
7580 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7581 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007582
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007583
7584 Then one can run :
7585
7586 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7587
7588 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7589
7590 1
7591 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7592 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7593 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7594
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007595 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007596
7597 global
7598 stats socket /tmp/socket
7599 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7600
7601 defaults
7602 load-server-state-from-file local
7603
7604 backend bk
7605 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7606 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007609 Then one can run :
7610
7611 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7612
7613 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7614
7615 1
7616 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7617 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7618 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7619
7620 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7621 "show servers state"
7622
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007624log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007625log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007626 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007627no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007628 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007631
7632 Prefix :
7633 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7634 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7635 prefix does not allow arguments.
7636
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007637 Arguments :
7638 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7639 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7640 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7641 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7642 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7643 parameter.
7644
7645 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7646 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7647
7648 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7649 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7650 standard syslog port).
7651
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007652 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7653 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7654 standard syslog port).
7655
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007656 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7657 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7658 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007659 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007660
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007661 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7662 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7663 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7664 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7665 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7666 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7667 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7668 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7669 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7670 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7671 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7672 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007673 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007674 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7675 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7676 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007677 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7678 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007679
7680 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7681 and "fd@2", see above.
7682
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007683 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7684 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7685 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7686 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7687 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7688 having the logs instantly available.
7689
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007690 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7691 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7692 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7693
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007694 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7695 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007696
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007697 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7698 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7699 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7700 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7701 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7702 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7703 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7704 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7705 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7706 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007707 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007708
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007709 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7710 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7711 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7712 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7713 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7714
7715 <sample_size>
7716 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7717 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7718 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7719 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7720 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7721
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007722 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7723 one of the following :
7724
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007725 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7726 field is stripped. This is the default.
7727 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7728 rfc3164.
7729
7730 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007731 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7732
7733 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7734 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7735
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007736 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7737 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7738 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7739 designed to be used with a local log server.
7740
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007741 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7742 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7743 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7744 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7745 systemd logger consumes.
7746
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007747 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7748 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7749 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7750 used with a local log server.
7751
7752 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7753 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7754 designed to be used with a local log server.
7755
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007756 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7757 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7758 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7759 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007761 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7762
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007763 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7764 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7765 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7766
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007767 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7768 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7769 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7770 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007771
7772 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7773 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7774 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007775 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7776 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7777 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7778 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7779 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007780
7781 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7782
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007783 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7784 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7785 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007786
7787 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7788 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7789 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7790 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7791
7792 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7793 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007794
7795 Example :
7796 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007797 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7798 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7799 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007800 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007801 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7802 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007803 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007805
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007806log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007807 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7809 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007810
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007811 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7812 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7813 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7814 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7815 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007816
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007817 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7818 "option httplog" directives.
7819
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007820log-format-sd <string>
7821 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | no
7824
7825 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7826 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7827 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7828 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7829 which covers the log format string in depth.
7830
7831 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7832 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7833
7834 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7835 log format to "rfc5424".
7836
7837 Example :
7838 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7839
7840
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007841log-tag <string>
7842 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 yes | yes | yes | yes
7845
7846 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7847 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007848 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007849 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7850 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7851 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7852 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7853 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7854 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007855
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007856max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7857 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | no | yes | yes
7860
7861 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7862 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7863 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7864 servers.
7865
7866 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007867 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007868 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7869 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7870 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007871 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007872 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7873 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7874 picking a different server.
7875
7876 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7877 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7878 even if they have to be queued.
7879
7880 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7881 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7882
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007883max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7884 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7885 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7886 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007887
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007888maxconn <conns>
7889 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | yes | yes | no
7892 Arguments :
7893 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7894 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7895 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7896 closes.
7897
7898 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007899 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007900 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7901 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007902 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7903 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7904 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7905 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007906
7907 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7908 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7909 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7910
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007911 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7912 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7915
7916
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007917mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007918 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | yes
7921 Arguments :
7922 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7923 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7924 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7925 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7926
7927 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7928 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7929 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7930 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7931 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7932
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007933 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7934 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7935 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007936
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007937 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007938 defaults http_instances
7939 mode http
7940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007942monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007943 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007946 Arguments :
7947 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7948 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007949 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007950 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7951 backend and its backup.
7952
7953 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7954 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7955 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7956 servers in a list of backends.
7957
7958 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7959 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7960 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007961 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007962 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7963 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007964 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007965 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7966 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967
7968 Example:
7969 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007970 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007971 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7972 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7973 monitor-uri /site_alive
7974 monitor fail if site_dead
7975
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007976 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007977
7978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007979monitor-uri <uri>
7980 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 yes | yes | yes | no
7983 Arguments :
7984 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7985 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7986
7987 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7988 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7989 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7990 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7991 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7992 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7993 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7994 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7995
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007996 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007997 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7998 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7999 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8000 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8001 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8002 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008003
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008004 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8005 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8006 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8007 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008010 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008011 frontend www
8012 mode http
8013 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8014
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008015 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008018option abortonclose
8019no option abortonclose
8020 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | no | yes | yes
8023 Arguments : none
8024
8025 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8026 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8027 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8028 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008029 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008030 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8031 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8032 encountered while delivering the response.
8033
8034 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8035 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8036 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8037 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8038 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8039 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008040 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008041 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008042 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008043 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8044 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8045 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8046
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8048 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8050 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8051 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8052 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8053 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8054 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008055 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008056
8057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8059
8060 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8061
8062
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008063option accept-invalid-http-request
8064no option accept-invalid-http-request
8065 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8067 yes | yes | yes | no
8068 Arguments : none
8069
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008070 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008071 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008072 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008073 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8074 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8075 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8076 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8077 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008078 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8079 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8080 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8081 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008083 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008084 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8085 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8086 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008087
8088 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8089 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8090 been confirmed.
8091
8092 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8093 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008094 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8095 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008096 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8097
8098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8100
8101 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8102 stats socket.
8103
8104
8105option accept-invalid-http-response
8106no option accept-invalid-http-response
8107 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | no | yes | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008112 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008113 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008114 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008115 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8116 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8117 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8118 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8119 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008120 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8121 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8122 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008123
8124 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8125 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8126 been confirmed.
8127
8128 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8129 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8130 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8131 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8132
8133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8135
8136 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8137 stats socket.
8138
8139
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008140option allbackups
8141no option allbackups
8142 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 yes | no | yes | yes
8145 Arguments : none
8146
8147 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8148 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8149 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8150 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8151 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8152 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8153 order between the backup servers anymore.
8154
8155 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8156 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8157
8158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8160
8161
8162option checkcache
8163no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008164 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8166 yes | no | yes | yes
8167 Arguments : none
8168
8169 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8170 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008171 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008172 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8173 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008174 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175
8176 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008177 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008178 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008179 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8180 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008181 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008182 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008183 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8184 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008185 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008186 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8187 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008189 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8190 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8191 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8192 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8193 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8194 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8195 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8197 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8198
8199 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008200 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8201 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8202 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8203 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008204
8205 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8206 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008207 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008208 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008209
8210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8212
8213
8214option clitcpka
8215no option clitcpka
8216 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | yes | yes | no
8219 Arguments : none
8220
8221 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8222 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008224 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8225
8226 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8227 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8228 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8229 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8230
8231 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8232 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8233 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8234 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8235 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8236
8237 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8238
8239 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8240 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8241 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8242
8243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8245
8246 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8247
8248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008249option contstats
8250 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8252 yes | yes | yes | no
8253 Arguments : none
8254
8255 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8256 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8257 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008258 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008259 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8260 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8261 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8262 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8263 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008264
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008265option disable-h2-upgrade
8266no option disable-h2-upgrade
8267 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8268 connection.
8269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8270 yes | yes | yes | no
8271 Arguments : none
8272
8273 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8274 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8275 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8276 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008277 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8278 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8279 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8280 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8281 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8282 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008283
8284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008286
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008287option dontlog-normal
8288no option dontlog-normal
8289 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8291 yes | yes | yes | no
8292 Arguments : none
8293
8294 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8295 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8296 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8297 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8298 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8299 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8300 logged.
8301
8302 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8303 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8304 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008306 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008307 logging.
8308
8309
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008310option dontlognull
8311no option dontlognull
8312 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8314 yes | yes | yes | no
8315 Arguments : none
8316
8317 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8318 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8319 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8320 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8321 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8322 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008323 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8324 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8325 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008326
8327 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008328 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008329 would not be logged.
8330
8331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8333
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008334 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008335 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008336
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008338option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008339 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | yes
8342 Arguments :
8343 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8344 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008345 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008346 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008347
8348 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8349 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8350 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8351 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8352 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8353 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8354 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008355 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8356 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8357 possible that the client has already brought one.
8358
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008359 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008360 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008362 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008364 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008365
8366 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8367 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8368 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8369 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8370 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8371 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008372 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008373
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008374 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8375 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008376 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008377 are under the control of the end-user.
8378
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008379 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008380 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8381 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008382 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8383 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8384 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008385
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008386 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008387 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8388 frontend www
8389 mode http
8390 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8391
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008392 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8393 backend www
8394 mode http
8395 option forwardfor header X-Client
8396
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008397 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008398 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008399
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008400
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008401option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8402no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8403 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8405 yes | yes | yes | no
8406 Arguments : none
8407
8408 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8409 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8410 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8411 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8412 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8413 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8414 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8415
8416 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8417 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8418 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8419 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8420 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8421 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8422 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8423 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8424 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8425 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8426
8427 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8428
8429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8431
8432 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8433 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8434
8435
8436option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8437no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8438 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | no | yes | yes
8441 Arguments : none
8442
8443 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8444 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8445 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8446 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8447 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8448 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8449 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8450
8451 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8452 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8453 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8454 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8455 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8456 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8457 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8458 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8459 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8460 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8461
8462 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8463
8464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8466
8467 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8468 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8469
8470
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008471option http-buffer-request
8472no option http-buffer-request
8473 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8475 yes | yes | yes | yes
8476 Arguments : none
8477
8478 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8479 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8480 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8481 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8482 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8483 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008484 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8485 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8486 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8487 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008488
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008489 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8490 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008491
8492
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008493option http-ignore-probes
8494no option http-ignore-probes
8495 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8497 yes | yes | yes | no
8498 Arguments : none
8499
8500 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8501 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8502 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8503 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8504 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8505 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8506 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8507 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8508 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008509 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8510 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008511 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8512
8513 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8514 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8515 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8516 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8517 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8518 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8519 are often the only way to detect them.
8520
8521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8523
8524 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8525
8526
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008527option http-keep-alive
8528no option http-keep-alive
8529 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8531 yes | yes | yes | yes
8532 Arguments : none
8533
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008534 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8535 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008536 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8537 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008538 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8539 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8540 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008541
8542 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8543 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008544 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8545 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8546 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8547 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8548 situations where this option may be useful :
8549
8550 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008552
8553 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8554 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8555
8556 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8557 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8558 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8559 request.
8560
8561 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8562 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008563 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8564 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8565 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008566
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008567 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8568 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8569 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8570 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8571 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8572 not set.
8573
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008574 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8575 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8576 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008578 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008579 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008580 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008581
8582
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008583option http-no-delay
8584no option http-no-delay
8585 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 yes | yes | yes | yes
8588 Arguments : none
8589
8590 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8591 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8592 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8593 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8594 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8595 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8596 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008597 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008598 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8599 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8600 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8601 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8602 affected.
8603
8604 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8605 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8606 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8607 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8608 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8609 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8610 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8611 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8612 latency environments.
8613
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008614 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8615
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008616
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008617option http-pretend-keepalive
8618no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008619 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008621 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008622 Arguments : none
8623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008624 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008625 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8626 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8627 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008628 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008629 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8630 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8631 consider the response complete.
8632
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008633 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008634 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008635 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008636 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008637 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008638 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8639
8640 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8641 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8642 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8643 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008644 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8645 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008646 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8647
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008648 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8649 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8650 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8651 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8652 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8653 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008654
8655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8657
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008658 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008659 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008661
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008662option http-server-close
8663no option http-server-close
8664 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8666 yes | yes | yes | yes
8667 Arguments : none
8668
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008669 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8670 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8671 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8672 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008673 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8674 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8675 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8676 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8677 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8678 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8679 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8680 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8681 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8682 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8683 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008684
8685 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8686 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8687 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8688 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008689 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8690 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008691
8692 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8693 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008694 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8695 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8696 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008697
8698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8700
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008701 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8702 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008703
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008704option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008705no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008706 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | yes | yes | no
8709 Arguments : none
8710
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008711 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008712 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8713 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8714 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8715 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8716 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008717 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008718
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008719 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008720 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008721 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8722 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8723 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008724
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008725 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8726 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8727 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8728 front of an existing proxy.
8729
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008730 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8731
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008732 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008734option httpchk
8735option httpchk <uri>
8736option httpchk <method> <uri>
8737option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008738 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8740 yes | no | yes | yes
8741 Arguments :
8742 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8743 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8744 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8745 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8746 ones.
8747
8748 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8749 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8750 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8751
8752 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8753 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8754 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008755 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756
8757 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8758 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8759 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8760 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8761 the lack of any response.
8762
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008763 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8764 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8765 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8766 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8767
8768 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8769 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8770 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008771
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008772 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8773 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008774 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008775 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008776 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008778 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8779 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8780 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8781 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008783 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008784 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8785 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8786 backend https_relay
8787 mode tcp
8788 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8789 http-check send hdr Host www
8790 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008792 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8793 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8794 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008795
8796
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008797option httpclose
8798no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008799 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8801 yes | yes | yes | yes
8802 Arguments : none
8803
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008804 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8805 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8806 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8807 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008808 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008809
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008810 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8811 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008812 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008813 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8814 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008815
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008816 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8817 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8818 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008819
8820 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8821 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008822 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8823 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8824 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008825
8826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8828
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008829 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008830
8831
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008832option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008833 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008835 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008836 Arguments :
8837 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8838 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8839 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008841 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008842
8843 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8844 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8845 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8846 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8847 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8848 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8849 ports.
8850
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008851 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8852 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008853
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008854 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008856 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008858
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008859option independent-streams
8860no option independent-streams
8861 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8863 yes | yes | yes | yes
8864 Arguments : none
8865
8866 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8867 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8868 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8869 receive data or not.
8870
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008872 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8873 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8874 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8875 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8876 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8877 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8878 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8879 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8880 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8881 socket buffers.
8882
8883 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8884 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8885 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8886 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8887 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8888
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008889 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008890
8891
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008892option ldap-check
8893 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8895 yes | no | yes | yes
8896 Arguments : none
8897
8898 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8899 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8900 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8901 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8902
8903 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8904 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8905
8906 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8907 configure it.
8908
8909 Example :
8910 option ldap-check
8911
8912 See also : "option httpchk"
8913
8914
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008915option external-check
8916 Use external processes for server health checks
8917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8918 yes | no | yes | yes
8919
8920 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8921 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8922 command".
8923
8924 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8925
8926 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8927
8928
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008929option log-health-checks
8930no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008931 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8933 yes | no | yes | yes
8934 Arguments : none
8935
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008936 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8937 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8938 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008939
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008940 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8941 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8942 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8943 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8944 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008946 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008947 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008948
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008949 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8950 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8951 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008952
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008953
8954option log-separate-errors
8955no option log-separate-errors
8956 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8958 yes | yes | yes | no
8959 Arguments : none
8960
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008961 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008962 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8963 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8964 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8965 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8966 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8967 provides very important information.
8968
8969 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8970 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8971 error logs.
8972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008974 logging.
8975
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008976
8977option logasap
8978no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008979 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | yes | yes | no
8982 Arguments : none
8983
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008984 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8985 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8986 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8987 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8988
8989 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8990 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8991 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8992 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8993 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008994 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008995 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8996 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8997 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8998 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008999 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009000
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009001 Examples :
9002 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9003 mode http
9004 option httplog
9005 option logasap
9006 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9007
9008 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9009 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9010 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9011 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009013 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009014 logging.
9015
9016
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009017option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009018 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9020 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009021 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009022 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9023 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009024 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9025 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009026
9027 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9028 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009029 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009030 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009031 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9032 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9033 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009034
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009035 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9036 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9037 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009038
9039 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009040 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009041 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9042 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9043 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9044 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9045 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9046 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9047 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9048
9049 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9050 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009051
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009052 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009053
9054 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9055 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9056 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9057 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009058 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009059 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009060
9061 See also: "option httpchk"
9062
9063
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009064option nolinger
9065no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009066 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009069 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009070
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009071 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009072 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9073 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9074 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9075 connections.
9076
9077 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9078 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009079 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9080 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9081 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9082 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9083 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9084 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9085 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9086 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9087 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9088 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9089 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9090 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9091 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009092
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009093 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9094 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9095 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9096 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9097 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009098
9099 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9100 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009101 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009102 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009103 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009104
9105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9107
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009108 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9109 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009111option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9112 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9114 yes | yes | yes | yes
9115 Arguments :
9116 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9117 matching <network>
9118 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9119 header name.
9120
9121 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9122 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9123 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9124 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9125 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9126 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9127 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9128 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9129 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9130 possible that the client has already brought one.
9131
9132 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9133 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9134 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9135 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9136 header and requires different one.
9137
9138 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9139 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9140 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009141 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9142 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9143 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9144 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9145 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009146
9147 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9148 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9149 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9150 both are defined.
9151
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009152 Examples :
9153 # Original Destination address
9154 frontend www
9155 mode http
9156 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9157
9158 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9159 backend www
9160 mode http
9161 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9162
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009163 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009164
9165
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009166option persist
9167no option persist
9168 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9170 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009171 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009172
9173 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9174 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9175 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9176 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9177 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9178 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9179 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9180 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9181 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9182 redirected to another valid server.
9183
9184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9186
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009187 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009188
9189
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009190option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9191 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 yes | no | yes | yes
9194 Arguments :
9195 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9196 PostgreSQL server.
9197
9198 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9199 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9200 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9201 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9202
9203 See also: "option httpchk"
9204
9205
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009206option prefer-last-server
9207no option prefer-last-server
9208 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | no | yes | yes
9211 Arguments : none
9212
9213 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009214 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009215 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9216 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009217 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009218 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009219 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009220 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9221 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009222 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009223 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009224 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9225 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9226 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009227 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9228 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9229 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009230
9231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9233
9234 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9235
9236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009237option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009238option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009239no option redispatch
9240 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9242 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009243 Arguments :
9244 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9245 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9246 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009247 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009248 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009249 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009250 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9251 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9252 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009254
9255 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9256 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9257 be able to access the service anymore.
9258
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009259 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9260 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009261
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009262 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9263 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9264 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9265 following order:
9266
9267 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9268
9269 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9270 list, or
9271
9272 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9273
9274 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9275 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9276
9277 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9278 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9279 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9280 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9281
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009282 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009283 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9284 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9288
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009289 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009290
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009291
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009292option redis-check
9293 Use redis health checks for server testing
9294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9295 yes | no | yes | yes
9296 Arguments : none
9297
9298 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9299 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9300 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9301 find the "+PONG" response message.
9302
9303 Example :
9304 option redis-check
9305
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009306 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009307
9308
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009309option smtpchk
9310option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9311 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9313 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009314 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009315 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009316 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009317 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9318
9319 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9320 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9321 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9322
9323 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9324 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9325 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9326 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9327 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9328 dead server.
9329
9330 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9331 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009332 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009333 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9334
9335 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9336 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9337 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9338 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009339 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009340
9341 Example :
9342 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9343
9344 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009347option socket-stats
9348no option socket-stats
9349
9350 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 yes | yes | yes | no
9353
9354 Arguments : none
9355
9356
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009357option splice-auto
9358no option splice-auto
9359 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 yes | yes | yes | yes
9362 Arguments : none
9363
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009364 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009365 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009367 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009368 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009369 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9370 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9371 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9372 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9373
9374 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9375 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9376 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9377 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9378 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9379 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9380 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9381 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9382 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9383 keyword.
9384
9385 Example :
9386 option splice-auto
9387
9388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9390
9391 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9392 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9393
9394
9395option splice-request
9396no option splice-request
9397 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9399 yes | yes | yes | yes
9400 Arguments : none
9401
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009402 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009403 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009404 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9405 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9406 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9407 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9408
9409 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9410
9411 Example :
9412 option splice-request
9413
9414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9416
9417 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9418 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9419
9420
9421option splice-response
9422no option splice-response
9423 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9425 yes | yes | yes | yes
9426 Arguments : none
9427
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009428 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009429 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009430 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9431 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9432 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9433 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9434
9435 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9436
9437 Example :
9438 option splice-response
9439
9440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9442
9443 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9444 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9445
9446
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009447option spop-check
9448 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 no | no | no | yes
9451 Arguments : none
9452
9453 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9454 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9455 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9456 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9457
9458 Example :
9459 option spop-check
9460
9461 See also : "option httpchk"
9462
9463
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009464option srvtcpka
9465no option srvtcpka
9466 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9468 yes | no | yes | yes
9469 Arguments : none
9470
9471 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9472 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009473 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009474 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9475
9476 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9477 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9478 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9479 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9480
9481 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9482 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9483 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9484 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9485 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9486
9487 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9488
9489 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9490 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9491 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9492
9493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9495
9496 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9497
9498
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009499option ssl-hello-chk
9500 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9502 yes | no | yes | yes
9503 Arguments : none
9504
9505 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9506 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9507 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9508 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9509 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9510 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9511 hello message.
9512
9513 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9514 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9515 messages, which is appreciable.
9516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009517 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009518 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9519 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009520
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009521 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9522
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009523
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009524option tcp-check
9525 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9527 yes | no | yes | yes
9528
9529 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9530 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9531
9532 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9533 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9534 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9535
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009536 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009537 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9538 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9539 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9540 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9541 only.
9542
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009543 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009544 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009545 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9546 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9547 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9548
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009549 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009550 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9551 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009552 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009553 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9554 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9555 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9556 the respective protocols.
9557 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009558 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009559
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009560 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009561
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009562 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9563 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9564 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9565 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009566
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009567 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9568 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9569 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009570
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009571
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009573 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009574 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009575 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009576
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009577 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009578 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009579 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009580
9581 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9582 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009583 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009584 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009585 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009586 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009587 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009588 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009589 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9590 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009591 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009592 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9593 tcp-check expect string +OK
9594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009595 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009596 (send many headers before analyzing)
9597 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009598 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009599 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9600 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9601 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9602 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009603 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009604
9605
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009606 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607
9608
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009609option tcp-smart-accept
9610no option tcp-smart-accept
9611 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 yes | yes | yes | no
9614 Arguments : none
9615
9616 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9617 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9618 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9619 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9620 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9621 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9622
9623 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9624 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9625 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9626 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9627
9628 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9629 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9630 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009632
9633 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9634 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9635 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9636
9637 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9638 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9639 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9640
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009641 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9642
9643
9644option tcp-smart-connect
9645no option tcp-smart-connect
9646 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9648 yes | no | yes | yes
9649 Arguments : none
9650
9651 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9652 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9653 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9654 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9655 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9656
9657 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9658 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9659 complex.
9660
9661 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9662 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9663 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9664
9665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9667
9668 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9669
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009670
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009671option tcpka
9672 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9674 yes | yes | yes | yes
9675 Arguments : none
9676
9677 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9678 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009680 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9681
9682 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9683 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9684 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9685 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9686
9687 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9688 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9689 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9690 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9691 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9692
9693 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9694
9695 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9696 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9697 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9698 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9699 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9700 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9701 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9702 backends.
9703
9704 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009706
9707option tcplog
9708 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009710 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009711 Arguments : none
9712
9713 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9714 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9715 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9716 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9717 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9718 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9719 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9720 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9721
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009722 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009724 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009725
9726
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009727option transparent
9728no option transparent
9729 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009731 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009732 Arguments : none
9733
9734 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9735 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9736 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9737 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9738 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9739 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9740 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9741 appropriate server.
9742
9743 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9744 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9745
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009746 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009747 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009748
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009749
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009750external-check command <command>
9751 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9753 yes | no | yes | yes
9754
9755 Arguments :
9756 <command> is the external command to run
9757
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009758 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9759
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009760 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009761
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009762 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9763 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9764 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9765 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9766 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9767 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009768
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009769 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9770
9771 Environment variables :
9772 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9773 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9774
9775 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9776
9777 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9778
9779 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9780 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9781 for a UNIX socket).
9782
9783 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9784
9785 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9786
9787 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9788
9789 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9790
9791 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9792
9793 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9794 socket).
9795
9796 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9797 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9798
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009799 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9800
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009801 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9802 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9803 failed.
9804
9805 Example :
9806 external-check command /bin/true
9807
9808 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9809
9810
9811external-check path <path>
9812 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9814 yes | no | yes | yes
9815
9816 Arguments :
9817 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9818
9819 The default path is "".
9820
9821 Example :
9822 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9823
9824 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9825 "external-check command"
9826
9827
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009828persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009829persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009830 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9832 yes | no | yes | yes
9833 Arguments :
9834 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009835 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9836 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009837
9838 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9839 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009840 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009841 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9842 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9843 forwarded to this server.
9844
9845 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9846 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9847 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009848 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009849 a single "listen" section.
9850
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009851 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9852 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9853 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9854
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009855 Example :
9856 listen tse-farm
9857 bind :3389
9858 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9859 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9860 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9861 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9862 persist rdp-cookie
9863 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009864 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009865 balance rdp-cookie
9866 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9867 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9868
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009869 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9870 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009871
9872
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009873rate-limit sessions <rate>
9874 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | yes | yes | no
9877 Arguments :
9878 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9879 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9880
9881 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9882 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9883 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009884 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009885 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9886 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9887
9888 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9889 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9890 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9891 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9892
9893 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9894 listen smtp
9895 mode tcp
9896 bind :25
9897 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009898 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009899
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009900 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9901 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9902 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009903
9904 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9905
9906
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009907redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9908redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9909redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009910 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 no | yes | yes | yes
9913
9914 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009915 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009916
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009918 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009919 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9920 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9921 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009922
9923 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9924 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9925 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9926 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9927 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009928 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9929 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9930 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9931 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009932
9933 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9934 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9935 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9936 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9937 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9938 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009939 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009940 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009941 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9942 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9943 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009944
9945 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009946 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9947 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9948 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009949 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009950 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9951 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9952 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9953 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009954
9955 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009956 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009957
9958 - "drop-query"
9959 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9960 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9961 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9962 with a location-type redirect.
9963
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009964 - "append-slash"
9965 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9966 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9967 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9968 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9969
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009970 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9971 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9972 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9973 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9974 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9975 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9976 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9977
9978 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9979 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9980 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9981 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9982 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9983 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9984 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009985
9986 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9987 acl clear dst_port 80
9988 acl secure dst_port 8080
9989 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009990 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009991 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9993
9994 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009995 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9996 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9997 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009998 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009999
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010000 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10001 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10002 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10003
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010004 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010005 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010006
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010007 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010008 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10009 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10010 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010012 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010013
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010014
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010015retries <value>
10016 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10018 yes | no | yes | yes
10019 Arguments :
10020 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10021 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10022 default value is 3.
10023
10024 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10025 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10026 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10027
10028 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010029 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10030 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010031
10032 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10033 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10034
10035 See also : "option redispatch"
10036
10037
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010038retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010039 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10040 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10041 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10043 yes | no | yes | yes
10044 Arguments :
10045 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10046 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10047 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10048 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10049
10050 none never retry
10051
10052 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10053 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10054
10055 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10056 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10057 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10058 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10059 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10060 processing the request.
10061
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010062 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10063 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10064 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10065 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10066 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10067 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10068 overflow attack for example).
10069
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010070 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10071 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10072 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10073 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10074 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10075 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10076 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10077 amplify denial of service attacks.
10078
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010079 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10080 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10081 considered to be safe to retry.
10082
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010083 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10084 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10085 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10086 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10087 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010088
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010089 all-retryable-errors
10090 retry request for any error that are considered
10091 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10092 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10093 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10094
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010095 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10096 not cumulative.
10097
10098 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10099 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10100 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10101 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10102
10103 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10104 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10105 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10106 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10107 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10108 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10109 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10110 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10111 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10112 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10113 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10114 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10115
10116 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10117 should not use this directive.
10118
10119 The default is "conn-failure".
10120
10121 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10122
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010123server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010124 Declare a server in a backend
10125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10126 no | no | yes | yes
10127 Arguments :
10128 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010129 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010130 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010131
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010132 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10133 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10134 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10135 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010136 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10137 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010138 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010139 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10140 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010141 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10142 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10143 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10144 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10145 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10146 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10147 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010148 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010149 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10150 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10151 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10152 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10153 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10154 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010155 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10156 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010157 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10158 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010160 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010161 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10162 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10163 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10164 adding this value to the client's port.
10165
10166 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10167 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010168 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010169
10170 Examples :
10171 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10172 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010173 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010174 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10175 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10176 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010177
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010178 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10179 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10180 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10181 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10182 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10183
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010184 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10185 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010186
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010187server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010188 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010189 this backend.
10190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10191 no | no | yes | yes
10192
10193 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10194 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10195 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10196 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10197 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010198
10199 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10200 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10201
10202 global
10203 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10204
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010205 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010206 load-server-state-from-file
10207
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010208 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010209 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010210
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010211server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10212 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10213 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10215 no | no | yes | yes
10216
10217 Arguments:
10218 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10219
10220 <num | range>
10221 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10222 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10223 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10224 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10225
10226 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10227
10228 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10229
10230 <params*>
10231 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10232 keyword.
10233
10234 Examples:
10235 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10236 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10237 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10238
10239 # or
10240 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10241
10242 # would be equivalent to:
10243 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10244 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10245 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10246
10247
10248
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010249source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010250source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010251source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010252 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10254 yes | no | yes | yes
10255 Arguments :
10256 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10257 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010258
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010259 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010260 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10261 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10262 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10263 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10264 supported prefixes are :
10265 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10266 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10267 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010268 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010269 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10270 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010271
10272 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10273 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010274 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10275 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10276 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010277
10278 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10279 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10280 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10281 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10282 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10283 <addr>.
10284
10285 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10286 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10287 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10288 port.
10289
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010290 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10291 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10292 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10293 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010294 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010295 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10296 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10297 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10298 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10299 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10300 HTTP header.
10301
10302 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10303 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010304 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010305 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10306 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10307 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10308 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10309 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10310 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10311 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10312
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010313 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10314 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10315 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10316 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10317 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10318 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10319
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010320 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10321 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10322 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10323 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10324
10325 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10326 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10327 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10328 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10329 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10330 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10331
10332 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10333 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10334 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10335 there are two methods :
10336
10337 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10338 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10339 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10340 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10341 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10342 of the client ranges may be used.
10343
10344 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10345 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10346 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10347 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10348 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10349 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10350 same session.
10351
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10353 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10354 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010355 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010357 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10358
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010359 Examples :
10360 backend private
10361 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10362 source 192.168.1.200
10363
10364 backend transparent_ssl1
10365 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10366 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10367
10368 backend transparent_ssl2
10369 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10370 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10371 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10372
10373 backend transparent_ssl3
10374 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10375 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10376 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10377
10378 backend transparent_smtp
10379 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10380 # with Tproxy version 4.
10381 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10382
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010383 backend transparent_http
10384 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10385 # proxy.
10386 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010388 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010389 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10390
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010391
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010392srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10393 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10394 the connection on the server side.
10395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10396 yes | no | yes | yes
10397 Arguments :
10398 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10399
10400 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10401 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010402 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10403 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010404
10405 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10406
10407
10408srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10409 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10410 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10411 server side.
10412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10413 yes | no | yes | yes
10414 Arguments :
10415 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10416 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10417 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10418 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10419
10420 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10421 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010422 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10423 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010424
10425 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10426
10427
10428srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10429 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10431 yes | no | yes | yes
10432 Arguments :
10433 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10434 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10435 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10436 document.
10437
10438 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10439 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010440 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10441 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010442
10443 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10444
10445
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010446stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10447 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010449 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010450
10451 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10452 matched.
10453
10454 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10455 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10456
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010457 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10458 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10459 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10460 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010461
10462 Example :
10463 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10464 backend stats_localhost
10465 stats enable
10466 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10467
10468 Example :
10469 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10470 backend stats_auth
10471 stats enable
10472 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10473 stats admin if TRUE
10474
10475 Example :
10476 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10477 userlist stats-auth
10478 group admin users admin
10479 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10480 group readonly users haproxy
10481 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10482
10483 backend stats_auth
10484 stats enable
10485 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10486 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10487 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10488 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10489
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010490 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10491 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010492
10493
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010494stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10495 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010497 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498 Arguments :
10499 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10500
10501 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10502
10503 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10504 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10505 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10506 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10507 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10508 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10509
10510 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10511 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10512 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010513 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010514
10515 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10516 report using "stats scope".
10517
10518 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10519 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10520 unobvious parameters.
10521
10522 Example :
10523 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10524 backend public_www
10525 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10526 stats enable
10527 stats hide-version
10528 stats scope .
10529 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010531 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10532 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10533
10534 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10535 backend private_monitoring
10536 stats enable
10537 stats uri /admin?stats
10538 stats refresh 5s
10539
10540 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10541
10542
10543stats enable
10544 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010546 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547 Arguments : none
10548
10549 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10550 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10551 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10552 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10553 - stats auth : no authentication
10554 - stats scope : no restriction
10555
10556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10558 unobvious parameters.
10559
10560 Example :
10561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10562 backend public_www
10563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10564 stats enable
10565 stats hide-version
10566 stats scope .
10567 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010568 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10571
10572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10573 backend private_monitoring
10574 stats enable
10575 stats uri /admin?stats
10576 stats refresh 5s
10577
10578 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10579
10580
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010581stats hide-version
10582 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010585 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010586
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010587 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10588 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10589 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10590 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10591 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10592 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010594 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10595 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10596 unobvious parameters.
10597
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010598 Example :
10599 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10600 backend public_www
10601 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010602 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010603 stats hide-version
10604 stats scope .
10605 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010607 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10608 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010609
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010610 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10611 backend private_monitoring
10612 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613 stats uri /admin?stats
10614 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010615
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010616 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010617
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010618
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010619stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10620 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10621 Access control for statistics
10622
10623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10624 no | no | yes | yes
10625
10626 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10627 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10628 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10629 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10630 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10631 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10632
10633 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10634 instance.
10635
10636 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10637 about ACL usage.
10638
10639
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010640stats realm <realm>
10641 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010644 Arguments :
10645 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10646 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10647 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10648
10649 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10650 using a backslash ('\').
10651
10652 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10653 only related to authentication.
10654
10655 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10656 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10657 unobvious parameters.
10658
10659 Example :
10660 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10661 backend public_www
10662 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10663 stats enable
10664 stats hide-version
10665 stats scope .
10666 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010667 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010668 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10669 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10670
10671 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10672 backend private_monitoring
10673 stats enable
10674 stats uri /admin?stats
10675 stats refresh 5s
10676
10677 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10678
10679
10680stats refresh <delay>
10681 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010683 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010684 Arguments :
10685 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10686 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10687 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10688 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10689 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10690 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10691
10692 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10693 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10694 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010695 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010696
10697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10699 unobvious parameters.
10700
10701 Example :
10702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10703 backend public_www
10704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10705 stats enable
10706 stats hide-version
10707 stats scope .
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10712
10713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10714 backend private_monitoring
10715 stats enable
10716 stats uri /admin?stats
10717 stats refresh 5s
10718
10719 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10720
10721
10722stats scope { <name> | "." }
10723 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments :
10727 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10728 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10729 section in which the statement appears.
10730
10731 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10732 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10733 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10734 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10735 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10736 exists.
10737
10738 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10739 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10740 unobvious parameters.
10741
10742 Example :
10743 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10744 backend public_www
10745 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10746 stats enable
10747 stats hide-version
10748 stats scope .
10749 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010750 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010751 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10752 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10753
10754 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10755 backend private_monitoring
10756 stats enable
10757 stats uri /admin?stats
10758 stats refresh 5s
10759
10760 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010762
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010763stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010764 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010766 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010767
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010768 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010769 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10770
10771 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10772 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10773
10774 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10775 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010776 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777
10778 Example :
10779 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10780 backend private_monitoring
10781 stats enable
10782 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10783 stats uri /admin?stats
10784 stats refresh 5s
10785
10786 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10787 global section.
10788
10789
10790stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010791 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10793 yes | yes | yes | yes
10794 Arguments : none
10795
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010796 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010797 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10798 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10799 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10800 - IP (socket, server)
10801 - cookie (backend, server)
10802
10803 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10804 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010805 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806
10807 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10808
10809
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010810stats show-modules
10811 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10813 yes | yes | yes | yes
10814 Arguments : none
10815
10816 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10817 values as a tooltip.
10818
10819 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10820 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10821 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10822
10823 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10824
10825
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010826stats show-node [ <name> ]
10827 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010830 Arguments:
10831 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10832 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10833
10834 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10835 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010836 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010837
10838 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10839 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10840 unobvious parameters.
10841
10842 Example:
10843 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10844 backend private_monitoring
10845 stats enable
10846 stats show-node Europe-1
10847 stats uri /admin?stats
10848 stats refresh 5s
10849
10850 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10851 section.
10852
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010853
10854stats uri <prefix>
10855 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010857 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010858 Arguments :
10859 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10860 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10861 query string.
10862
10863 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10864 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10865 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10866 possible to reach it in the application.
10867
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010868 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010869 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010870 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10871 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10872 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10873 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10874
10875 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10876 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10877 an address or a port to statistics only.
10878
10879 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10880 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10881 unobvious parameters.
10882
10883 Example :
10884 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10885 backend public_www
10886 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10887 stats enable
10888 stats hide-version
10889 stats scope .
10890 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010891 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10893 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10894
10895 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10896 backend private_monitoring
10897 stats enable
10898 stats uri /admin?stats
10899 stats refresh 5s
10900
10901 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10902
10903
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010904stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10905 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010907 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010908
10909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010910 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010911 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010912 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010913 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10914
10915 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10916 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10917 the "stick-table" statement.
10918
10919 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10920 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10921 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10922 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10923 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10924
10925 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10926 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10927 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10928 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10929 transformation rules.
10930
10931 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10932 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10933 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10934 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10935 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10936 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10937 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10938
10939 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10940 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10941 ACL based conditions.
10942
10943 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10944 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10945 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10946 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10947
10948 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10949 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10950 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10951 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10952
10953 Example :
10954 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10955 # last 30 minutes
10956 backend pop
10957 mode tcp
10958 balance roundrobin
10959 stick store-request src
10960 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10961 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10962 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10963
10964 backend smtp
10965 mode tcp
10966 balance roundrobin
10967 stick match src table pop
10968 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10969 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10970
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010971 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
10972 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010973
10974
10975stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10976 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10978 no | no | yes | yes
10979
10980 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10981 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10982 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10983 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10984
10985 Examples :
10986 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010987 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010988
10989 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10990 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10991 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10992
10993
10994 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10995 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10996 backend http
10997 mode http
10998 balance roundrobin
10999 stick on src table https
11000 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11001 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11002 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11003
11004 backend https
11005 mode tcp
11006 balance roundrobin
11007 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11008 stick on src
11009 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11010 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11011
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011012 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011013
11014
11015stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11016 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11018 no | no | yes | yes
11019
11020 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011021 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011022 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011023 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011024 server is selected.
11025
11026 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11027 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11028 the "stick-table" statement.
11029
11030 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11031 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11032 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11033 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11034 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11035 address.
11036
11037 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11038 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11039 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11040 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11041 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11042 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11043 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11044 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11045 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11046 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11047
11048 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11049 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11050 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11051 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11052 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11053 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11054 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11055
11056 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11057 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11058 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11059 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11060
11061 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11062 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11063 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11064 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11065 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11066 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011067 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11068 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11069 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11070 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11071 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11072 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011073
11074 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11075 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11076 the request.
11077
11078 Example :
11079 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11080 # last 30 minutes
11081 backend pop
11082 mode tcp
11083 balance roundrobin
11084 stick store-request src
11085 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11086 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11087 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11088
11089 backend smtp
11090 mode tcp
11091 balance roundrobin
11092 stick match src table pop
11093 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11094 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11095
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011096 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011097
11098
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011099stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011100 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011101 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011102 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011104 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011105
11106 Arguments :
11107 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11108 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11109 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11110 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11111
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011112 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11113 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11114 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11115 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11116
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011117 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11118 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11119 instance.
11120
11121 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11122 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11123 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11124 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11125 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11126 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011127 to 32 characters.
11128
11129 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11130 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11131 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011132 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011133 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11134 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011135
11136 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011137 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11138 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011139 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11140 increase.
11141
11142 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011143 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11144 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11145 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011146
11147 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011148 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011149 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11150 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011151 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11153 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11154 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11155 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11156 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11157 parameter (see below).
11158
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011159 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11160 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11161 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11162 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11163 soft restart.
11164
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011165 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11166 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11167 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11168 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011169 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011170 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011171 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11172 if not expiration delay is specified.
11173
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011174 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11175 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11176 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11177 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11178 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11179 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11180 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11181 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11182 token.
11183
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011184 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11185 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11186 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11187 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011188 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11189 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11190 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11191 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11192 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11193 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11194 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11195 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11196 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11197 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11198 types and their arguments.
11199
11200 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11201 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11202 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11203 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11204
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011205 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11206 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11207 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11208 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11209 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11210 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11211 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11212 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11213 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11214 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011215 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11216 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11217 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11218 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011219
11220 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11221 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11222 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11223 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11224 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11225 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11226 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11227 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11228 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11229 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11230 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11231 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011232 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11233 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11234 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11235 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011236
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011237 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11238 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11239 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011240 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011241
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011242 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11243 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11244 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011245 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011246 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011247 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011248
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011249 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11250 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11251 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11252 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11253
11254 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11255 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11256 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11257 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11258 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11259 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11260
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011261 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11262 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11263 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11264 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11265 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11266 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11267 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11268 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11269 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11270 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011271 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11272 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11273 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011274
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011275 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11276 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11277 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11278 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11279
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011280 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11281 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11282 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11283 they were received.
11284
11285 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11286 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11287 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11288 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11289 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11290
11291 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11292 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11293 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11294 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11295 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11296
11297 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11298 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11299 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11300
11301 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11302 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11303 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11304 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11305 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11306
11307 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11308 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11309 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11310 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11311 the client side.
11312
11313 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11314 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11315 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11316 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11317 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11318 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11319 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11320
11321 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11322 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11323 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11324 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11325 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11326 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011327 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011328
11329 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11330 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11331 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11332 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11333 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11334 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11335
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011336 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11337 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11338 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11339 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11340 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11341
11342 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11343 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11344 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11345 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11346 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11347 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11348
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011349 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011350 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011351 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11352 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11353
11354 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11355 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11356 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11357 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11358 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11359 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11360 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11361 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11362 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11363 recommended for better fairness.
11364
11365 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011366 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011367 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11368 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11369
11370 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11371 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11372 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11373 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11374 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11375 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11376 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11377 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11378 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11379 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011380
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011381 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11382 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011383 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11384 reference it.
11385
11386 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11387 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011388 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11389 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11390 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011391
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011392 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11393 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11394 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11395 something that can be ignored.
11396
11397 Example:
11398 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11399 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11400 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11401 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11402
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011403 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011404 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011405
11406
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011407stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011408 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11410 no | no | yes | yes
11411
11412 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011413 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011414 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011415 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011416 server is selected.
11417
11418 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11419 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11420 the "stick-table" statement.
11421
11422 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11423 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11424 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11425 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11426
11427 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11428 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11429 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11430 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11431 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11432 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011433 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011434 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11435 rules.
11436
11437 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11438 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11439 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11440 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11441 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11442 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11443 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11444
11445 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11446 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11447 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11448 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11449
11450 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11451 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11452 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11453 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11454 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11455 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011456 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11457 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11458 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11459 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11460 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11461 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11462 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11463 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11464 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011465
11466 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11467
11468 Example :
11469 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11470 backend https
11471 mode tcp
11472 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011473 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011474 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011475
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011476 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11477 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11478
11479 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11480 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11481 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11482
11483 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11484 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011485
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011486 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11487 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11488 # at offset 44.
11489
11490 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11491 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11492
11493 # Learn on response if server hello.
11494 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011495
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011496 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11497 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11498
11499 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11500 extraction.
11501
11502
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011503tcp-check comment <string>
11504 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11505 it fails.
11506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11507 yes | no | yes | yes
11508
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011509 Arguments :
11510 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11511 rule fails.
11512
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011513 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11514 user-friendly error reporting.
11515
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011516 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11517 "tcp-check expect".
11518
11519
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011520tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11521 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011522 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011523 Opens a new connection
11524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011525 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011526
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011527 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011528 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11529
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011530 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011531 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011532
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011533 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011534 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11535 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011536 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011537
11538 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011539
11540 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11541
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011542 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11543
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011544 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11545
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011546 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11547
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011548 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11549 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11550 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11551 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11552
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011553 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11554 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11555 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11556 haproxy -vv.
11557
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011558 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011559
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011560 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11561 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11562 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11563
11564 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11565 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11566 of the sequence.
11567
11568 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11569 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11570 do.
11571
11572 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11573 unset-var or comment rules.
11574
11575 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011576 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11577 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11578 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11579 option tcp-check
11580 tcp-check connect
11581 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11582 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11583 tcp-check send \r\n
11584 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11585 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11586 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11587 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11588 tcp-check send \r\n
11589 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11590 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11591
11592 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11593 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011594 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011595 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11596 tcp-check connect port 143
11597 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11598 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11599
11600 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11601
11602
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011603tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011604 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011605 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011606 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011607 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011608 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011609 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011610
11611 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011612 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11613
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011614 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11615 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11616 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11617 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11618 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11619 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11620 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11621 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11622 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11623 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11624
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011625 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011626 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11627 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011628 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11629 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11630 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11631
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011632 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11633 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11634 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011635 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11636 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011637 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11638 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011639 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11640 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011641 By default "L7OK" is used.
11642
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011643 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11644 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011645 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11646 supported :
11647 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11648 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011649 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11650 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11651 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11652 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11653 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011654
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011655 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011656 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011657 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11658 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11659 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11660 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011661 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11662
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011663 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11664 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11665 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11666 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11667
11668 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11669 informational message reported in logs if an error
11670 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11671 log-format string.
11672
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011673 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11674 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11675 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11676 followed by some converters.
11677
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011678 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11679 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11680 with the usual backslash ('\').
11681 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011682 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011683 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11684 used upper or lower case.
11685
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011686 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11687
11688 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11689 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11690 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11691 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11692 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11693 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11694 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11695 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11696
11697 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11698 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11699 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11700 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11701 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11702 expression.
11703
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011704 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11705 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11706 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11707 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11708 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11709 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11710
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011711 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11712 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11713 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11714 this exact hexadecimal string.
11715 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11716
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011717 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11718 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11719 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11720 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11721 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11722 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11723 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11724 size.
11725
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011726 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11727 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11728 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11729 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11730 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11731 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11732 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11733 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11734 in a binary string before matching the response's
11735 buffer.
11736
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011737 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011738 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011739 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11740 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11741 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11742 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11743 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11744 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11745 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11746 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11747 the null character.
11748
11749 Examples :
11750 # perform a POP check
11751 option tcp-check
11752 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11753
11754 # perform an IMAP check
11755 option tcp-check
11756 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11757
11758 # look for the redis master server
11759 option tcp-check
11760 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011761 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011762 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11763 tcp-check expect string role:master
11764 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11765 tcp-check expect string +OK
11766
11767
11768 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011769 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770
11771
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011772tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11773tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11774 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11775 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011777 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011778
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011779 Arguments :
11780 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11781
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011782 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11783 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011784
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011785 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11786 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011787
11788 Examples :
11789 # look for the redis master server
11790 option tcp-check
11791 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11792 tcp-check expect string role:master
11793
11794 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011795 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011796
11797
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011798tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11799tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11800 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11801 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011804
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011805 Arguments :
11806 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011807
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011808 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11809 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011810
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011811 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11812 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11813 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011814
11815 Examples :
11816 # redis check in binary
11817 option tcp-check
11818 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11819 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11820
11821
11822 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011823 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011824
11825
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011826tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011827 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011829 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011831 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011832 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11833 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11836 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11838 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11839 and '-'.
11840
11841 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11842
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011843 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011844 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11845
11846
11847tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011848 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011850 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011851
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011852 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011853 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11854 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11855 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11856 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11857 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11858 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11859 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11860 and '-'.
11861
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011862 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011863 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11864
11865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011866tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11867 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11869 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011871 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11872 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011875
11876 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11877 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011878 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11879 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11880 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11881 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11882 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11883 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011884
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011885 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11886 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11887 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11888 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011889
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011890 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011891 - accept :
11892 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11893 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11894 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011896 - reject :
11897 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11898 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11899 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11900 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11901 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11902 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11903 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11904 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11905 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11906 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11907 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011908 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011909
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011910 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11911 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11912 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11913 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11914 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11915 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11916 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11917 hosts.
11918
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011919 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11920 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11921 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11922 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11923 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11924 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11925 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11926 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11927
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011928 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11929 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11930 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11931 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11932 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11933 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11934 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11935 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11936 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011937 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11938 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011939
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011940 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011941 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011942 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11943 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11944 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011945 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011946 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011947 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11948 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11949 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11950 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11951 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11952 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11953 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011955 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011956 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011958 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011959 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11960 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11961 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011963 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11964 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11965 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11966 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011968 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11969 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11970 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11971 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11972 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011973 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11974 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11975 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11976 layer7 information is extracted.
11977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011978 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11979 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11980 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11981 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11982 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011983
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011984 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
11985 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
11986 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
11987 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
11988 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
11989 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
11990 no GPC stored at this index.
11991 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
11992 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
11993 data_types).
11994
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011995 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11996 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11997 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11998 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11999
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012000 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12001 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12002 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12003 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12004
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012005 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12006 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12007 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12008 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12009 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12010 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12011 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12012 no GPT stored at this index.
12013 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12014 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12015
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012016 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12017 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12018 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12019 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12020 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012021
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012022 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012023 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12024 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12025 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12026 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12027 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12028 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12029 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12030 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012031 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012032
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012033 - set-src <expr> :
12034 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12035 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12036 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012037 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012039 Arguments:
12040 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12041 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012042
12043 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012044 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12045
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012046 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12047 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012048
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012049 - set-src-port <expr> :
12050 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12051 expression.
12052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012053 Arguments:
12054 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12055 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012056
12057 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012058 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12059
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012060 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12061 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12062 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012063
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012064 - set-dst <expr> :
12065 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12066 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12067 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12068 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12069 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12070
12071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12072 followed by some converters.
12073
12074 Example:
12075
12076 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12077 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12078
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012079 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12080 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12081
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012082 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12083 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12084 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12085 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12086
12087
12088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12089 followed by some converters.
12090
12091 Example:
12092
12093 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12094
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012095 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12096 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12097 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12098
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012099 - set-tos <tos>:
12100 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12101 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12102 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12103 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12104 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12105 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12106 routers based on some information from the request.
12107
12108 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12109
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012110 - "silent-drop" :
12111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012112 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012113 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12114 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12115 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12116 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12117 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012118 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12119 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012120 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12121 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012123 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12124 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12125 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12126 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12129 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12130 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12133 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12134 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012136 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012137 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012138 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12141 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12142 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012143
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012144 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012145 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12146 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012147
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012148 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12149
12150 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12151
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012152 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12153
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012154 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012155
12156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012157tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12158 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012160 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012161 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012162 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12163 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012165 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012166
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012168 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12169 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012170 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12171 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012173 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12174 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12175 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12176 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012177 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012178 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012179 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12180 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12181 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12182 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012183 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012184 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012186 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12187 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12188 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12189 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012190
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012191 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012192 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012193 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012194 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12195 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012196 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012197 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012198 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012199 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012200 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012201 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012202 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012203 - set-dst <expr>
12204 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012205 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012206 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012207 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012208 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012209 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012210 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012211 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012212 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012214 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012216 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12217 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012218 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12219 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012220
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012221 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12222 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12223 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12224 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12225 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12226 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012228 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012229 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12230 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012231
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012232 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12233 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12234 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12235 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12236 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12237 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012239 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012240 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12241 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12242 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12243 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12244 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12245 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12246 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12247 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12248 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12249 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012250
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012251 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012252 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12253 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12254 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012255
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012256 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12257 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12258
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012259 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12260 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12261
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012262 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12263 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12264
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012265 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12266 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12267
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012268 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12269 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12270
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012271 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012272 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12273 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012274
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012275 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12276 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012277 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012278 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12279 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012280 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012281 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012282 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012283 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12284 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012285 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012286 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12287 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012288
12289 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12290 followed by some converters.
12291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012292 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012293 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12294 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12295 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12296 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12297 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12298 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012299 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012300 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12301 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12302
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012303 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12304
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012305 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12306 <var-name>.
12307
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012308 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12309 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12310 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12311 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12312 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12313
12314 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12315 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12316 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12317 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12318 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12319 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12320 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12321 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12322 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12323 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12324 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12325
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012326 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12327 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12328 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12329 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12330 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12331
12332 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12333
12334 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12335
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012336 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12337 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12338 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12339 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12340 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12341 evaluated.
12342
12343 Example:
12344 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12345
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012346 Example:
12347
12348 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012349 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012350
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012351 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012352 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012353 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012354 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12355 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012356 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012357 tcp-request content reject
12358
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012359 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12360 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12361 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12362 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12363 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12364 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12365 ...
12366 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012368 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012369 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12370 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12371 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012372 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012373
12374 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12375 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12376 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012377 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012378 tcp-request content reject
12379
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012380 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012381 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012382 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012383 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012384 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12385 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012386
12387 Example:
12388 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12389 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012390 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012391
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012392 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012393 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012394
12395 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012396 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012397 # protecting all our sites
12398 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012399 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12400 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012401 ...
12402 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12403
12404 backend http_dynamic
12405 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012406 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012407 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012408 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012409 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012410 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012411 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012414
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012415 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12416 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012417
12418
12419tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12420 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012422 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012423 Arguments :
12424 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12426 as explained at the top of this document.
12427
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012428 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012429 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12430 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12431 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12432 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12433
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012434 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12435 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12436 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12437 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12438
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012439 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012440 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012441 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012442 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012443 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012444 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12445 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12446 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012447
12448 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12449 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12450 it pass through unaffected.
12451
12452 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12453 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12454 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012455 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012456 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12457 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012458 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12459 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12460 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012462 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012463 "timeout client".
12464
12465
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012466tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12467 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12469 no | no | yes | yes
12470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012471 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12472 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012473
12474 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012476 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012477 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12478 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012479 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12480 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012481
12482 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12483
12484 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12485 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12486 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12487 inserted.
12488
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012489 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012490 - accept :
12491 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12492 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12493 the rules evaluation.
12494
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012495 - close :
12496 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12497 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12498 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12499 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12500 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12501 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012502 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012503 protocols.
12504
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012505 - reject :
12506 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12507 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012508 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012509
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012510 - set-log-level <level>
12511 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12512 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12513 set-log-level".
12514
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012515 - set-mark <mark>
12516 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12517 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12518 set-mark".
12519
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012520 - set-nice <nice>
12521 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12522 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12523 set-nice".
12524
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012525 - set-tos <tos>
12526 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12527 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12528 set-tos".
12529
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012530 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12531 Sets a variable.
12532
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012533 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12534 Unsets a variable.
12535
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012536 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12537 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12538 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12539 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12540 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12541 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12542 no GPC stored at this index.
12543 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12544 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12545 data_types).
12546
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012547 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12548 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12549 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12550 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12551
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012552 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12553 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12554 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12555 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12556
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012557 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12558 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12559 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12560 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12561 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12562 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12563 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12564 no GPT stored at this index.
12565 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12566 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12567
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012568 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12569 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12570 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12571 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12572 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012573
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012574 - "silent-drop" :
12575 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012576 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012577 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12578 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12579 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12580 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12581 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012582 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12583 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012584 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12585 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012586 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012587 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12588 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12589 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12590 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12591
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012592 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12593 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012595 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12596 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12597 for changing the default action to a reject.
12598
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012599 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12600 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12601 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12602 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012603 period.
12604
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012605 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12606 declared inline.
12607
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012608 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12609 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012610 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012611 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12612 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012613 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012615 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012616 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12617 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012619 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12620 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012621
12622 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12623 followed by some converters.
12624
12625 Example:
12626
12627 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12628
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012629 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12630 <var-name>.
12631
12632 Example:
12633
12634 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12635
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012636 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12637 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12638 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12639 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12640 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12641
12642 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12643
12644 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12645
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012646 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12647
12648 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12649
12650
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012651tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12652 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12654 no | yes | yes | no
12655 Arguments :
12656 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12657 below.
12658
12659 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012661 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012662 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12663 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12664 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12665 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12666 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12667 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12668 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012669 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012670 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12671 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12672 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12673 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12674 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12675 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12676 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12677 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12678 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12679 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12680 instead.
12681
12682 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12683 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12684 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12685 rules which may be inserted.
12686
12687 Several types of actions are supported :
12688 - accept : the request is accepted
12689 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12690 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012691 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012692 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012693 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012694 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012695 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012696 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012697 - set-dst <expr>
12698 - set-dst-port <expr>
12699 - set-src <expr>
12700 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012701 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012702 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012703 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012704 - silent-drop
12705
12706 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12707 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12708 sections for a complete description.
12709
12710 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12711 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12712 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12713
12714 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12715 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12716 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12717 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12718 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12719
12720 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12721 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12722
12723 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12724 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12725 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12726
12727 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12728 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12729 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12730
12731 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12732 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12733 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12734
12735 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12736 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12737 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12738
12739 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12740
12741 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12742
12743
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012744tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12747 no | no | yes | yes
12748 Arguments :
12749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12751 as explained at the top of this document.
12752
12753 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12754
12755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012756timeout check <timeout>
12757 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12758 established.
12759
12760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12761 yes | no | yes | yes
12762 Arguments:
12763 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12764 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12765 as explained at the top of this document.
12766
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012767 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012768 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012770 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012771 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12772 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12773 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012774
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012775 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012776 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12777
12778 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12779 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012780 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012781
12782 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12783 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12784 forget about it.
12785
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012786 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12787 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012788
12789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012790timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012791 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12793 yes | yes | yes | no
12794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12797 as explained at the top of this document.
12798
12799 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12800 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12801 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012802 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12803 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12804 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12805 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012806 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12807 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12808 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012809 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012810 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012811 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12812 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012813 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12814 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012815
12816 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12817 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12818 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12819 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012820 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012821 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12822
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012823 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012824
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012825 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012827
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012828timeout client-fin <timeout>
12829 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12831 yes | yes | yes | no
12832 Arguments :
12833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12835 as explained at the top of this document.
12836
12837 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12838 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12839 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12840 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12841 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12842 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12843 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012844 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12845 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12846 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012847
12848 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12849 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12850 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12851
12852 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12853
12854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012855timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012856 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12858 yes | no | yes | yes
12859 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12862 as explained at the top of this document.
12863
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012864 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012865 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012866 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012867 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012868 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12869 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012870
12871 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12872 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12873 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12874 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012875 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012876 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12877
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012878 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012881timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12882 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12884 yes | yes | yes | yes
12885 Arguments :
12886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12888 as explained at the top of this document.
12889
12890 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12891 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12892 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12893 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12894 once the request has started to present itself.
12895
12896 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12897 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12898 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12899 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12900 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12901
12902 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12903 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12904 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12905 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12906
12907 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12908 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012909 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012910 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12911 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012912 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012913
12914 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12915 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12916 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12917 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12918
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012919 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12920 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012921 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12922
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012923 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12924
12925
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012926timeout http-request <timeout>
12927 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012929 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012930 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012931 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012932 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12933 as explained at the top of this document.
12934
12935 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12936 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12937 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12938 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12939 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12940 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12941 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012942 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12943 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12944 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12945 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012946 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012947 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12948 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012949
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012950 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12951 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12952 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12953 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12954 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012955 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012956
12957 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12958 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012959 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012960 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12961 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12962
12963 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012964 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12965 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12966 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012967
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012968 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012969 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012970
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012971
12972timeout queue <timeout>
12973 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12975 yes | no | yes | yes
12976 Arguments :
12977 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12978 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12979 as explained at the top of this document.
12980
12981 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12982 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12983 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12984 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12985 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12986
12987 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12988 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12989 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12990 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12991
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012992 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012993
12994
12995timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012996 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12998 yes | no | yes | yes
12999 Arguments :
13000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13002 as explained at the top of this document.
13003
13004 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13005 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13006 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13007 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13008 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13009 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13010 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13011
13012 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13013 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13014 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13015 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13016 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013017 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013018 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013019 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13020 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013021 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13022 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013023
13024 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13025 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13026 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13027 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013028 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013029 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13030
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013031 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013032
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013033
13034timeout server-fin <timeout>
13035 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13037 yes | no | yes | yes
13038 Arguments :
13039 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13040 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13041 as explained at the top of this document.
13042
13043 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13044 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13045 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13046 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13047 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13048 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13049 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13050 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13051 situations, it should not be needed.
13052
13053 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13054 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13055 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13056
13057 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13058
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013059
13060timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013061 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13063 yes | yes | yes | yes
13064 Arguments :
13065 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13067 as explained at the top of this document.
13068
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013069 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13070 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13071 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013072
13073 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13074 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13075 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13076 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013077 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013078
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013079 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013080
13081
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013082timeout tunnel <timeout>
13083 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13085 yes | no | yes | yes
13086 Arguments :
13087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13089 as explained at the top of this document.
13090
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013091 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013092 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13093 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13094 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013095 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13096 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013097 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13098 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13099 specified.
13100
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013101 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13102 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13103 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13104 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13105 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13106 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13107 state.
13108
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013109 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13110 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13111 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13112 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013113 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013114
13115 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13116 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13117 forget about it.
13118
13119 Example :
13120 defaults http
13121 option http-server-close
13122 timeout connect 5s
13123 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013124 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013125 timeout server 30s
13126 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13127
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013128 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013129
13130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131transparent (deprecated)
13132 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013134 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013135 Arguments : none
13136
13137 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13138 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13139 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13140 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13141 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13142 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13143 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13144 appropriate server.
13145
13146 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13147
13148 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13149 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13150
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013151 See also: "option transparent"
13152
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013153unique-id-format <string>
13154 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13156 yes | yes | yes | no
13157 Arguments :
13158 <string> is a log-format string.
13159
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013160 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13161 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13162 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13163 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013164
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013165 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013166 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013167 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13168 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13169 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13170 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13171 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13172 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013173
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013174 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13175 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013176
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013177 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013178
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013179 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013180
13181 will generate:
13182
13183 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13184
13185 See also: "unique-id-header"
13186
13187unique-id-header <name>
13188 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13190 yes | yes | yes | no
13191 Arguments :
13192 <name> is the name of the header.
13193
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013194 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13195 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013197 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013198
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013199 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013200 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13201
13202 will generate:
13203
13204 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13205
13206 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013207
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013208use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013209 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13211 no | yes | yes | no
13212 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013213 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13214 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013215
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013216 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13217 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013218
13219 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13220 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13221 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013222 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013223 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013224 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13225 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013226
13227 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13228 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13229 assign the backend.
13230
13231 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13232 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13233 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13234 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13235 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13236 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13237
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013238 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013239 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013240 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13241 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13242 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13243
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013244 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13245 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13246 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13247 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13248 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13249 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13250 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13251 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13252 cannot be forced from the request.
13253
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013254 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013255 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13256 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13257
13258 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13259 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013260
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013261use-fcgi-app <name>
13262 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13264 no | no | yes | yes
13265 Arguments :
13266 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13267
13268 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013269
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013270use-server <server> if <condition>
13271use-server <server> unless <condition>
13272 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13274 no | no | yes | yes
13275 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013276 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13277 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013278
13279 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13280
13281 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13282 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13283 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13284
13285 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13286 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13287 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13288 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13289 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13290 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13291 matches will assign the server.
13292
13293 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13294 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13295 with the next rules until one matches.
13296
13297 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13298 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13299 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13300 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13301
13302 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13303 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13304 stripped.
13305
13306 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13307 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013308 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013309 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013310 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013311
13312 Example :
13313 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013314 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013315 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013316 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013317 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013318 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013319 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013320 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13321 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13322
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013323 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13324 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13325 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13326 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013327 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013328 and we fall back to load balancing.
13329
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013330 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013331
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133335. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013334--------------------------
13335
13336The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13337depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13338settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13339written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13340described in this section.
13341
13342
133435.1. Bind options
13344-----------------
13345
13346The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13347as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13348no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13349parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13350while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13351provided immediately after the setting name.
13352
13353The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13354
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013355accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13356 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13357 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13358 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13359 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13360 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13361 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13362 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13363 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13364 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013365 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13366 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13367 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013368
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013369accept-proxy
13370 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013371 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13372 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013373 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13374 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13375 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13376 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013377 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013378 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13379 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013380 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13381 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013382
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013383allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013384 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013385 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013386 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013387 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13388 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013389
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013390alpn <protocols>
13391 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13392 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13393 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013394 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013395 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013396 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13397 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13398 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13399 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13400 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13401 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13402 preference, like below :
13403
13404 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013405
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013406backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013407 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013408 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13409
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013410curves <curves>
13411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13412 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13413 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13414 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13415 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13416 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13417
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013418ecdhe <named curve>
13419 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013420 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13421 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013422
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013423ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013424 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13425 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13426 client's certificate.
13427
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013428ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13430 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13431 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13432 error is ignored.
13433
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013434ca-sign-file <cafile>
13435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13436 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13437 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13438 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13439 'generate-certificates' for details.
13440
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013441ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13443 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13444 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13445 'generate-certificates' for details.
13446
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013447ca-verify-file <cafile>
13448 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13449 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13450 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13451 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13452 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13453
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013454ciphers <ciphers>
13455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13456 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013457 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013458 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013459 information and recommendations see e.g.
13460 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13461 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13462 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13463
13464ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13466 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13467 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13468 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013469 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13470 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013471
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013472crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13474 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013475 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13476 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013477
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013478crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13480 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13481 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13482 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13483 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013484 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13485 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013486
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013487 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13488 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13489
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013490 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13491 are loaded.
13492
13493 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013494 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13495 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13496 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13497 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13498 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13499 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13500 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013501 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013502
13503 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13504 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13505 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13506 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013507 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13508 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013509
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013510 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013512 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013513 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013514 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13515 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013516 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13517 clients).
13518
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013519 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013520 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13521 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13522 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13523 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13524 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13525 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13526 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13527 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13528 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13529 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13530 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13531 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13532
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013533 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013534 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13535 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13536 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13537 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13538
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013539 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13540 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13541 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13542 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013543
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013544 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13545 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13546 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013547
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013548crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013550 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013551 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013552 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013553
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013554crt-list <file>
13555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013556 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13557 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013558
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013559 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13560
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013561 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13562 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13563 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13564 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13565 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013566
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013567 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013568 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13569 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13570 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13571 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13572 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013573 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13574 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13575 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013576
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013577 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13578 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13579 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013580
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013581 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13582
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013583 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013584 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013585 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13586 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13587 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13588 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13589 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13590 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013591
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013592 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013593 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013594 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013595 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013596 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013597 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013598
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013599defer-accept
13600 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13601 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13602 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013603 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013604 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13605 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13606 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13607 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13608 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13609 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13610 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13611
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013612expose-fd listeners
13613 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13614 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013615 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13616 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013618
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013619force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013620 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013621 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013622 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013623 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013624
13625force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013626 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013627 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013628 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013629
13630force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013631 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013632 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013633 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013634
13635force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013636 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013637 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013638 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013639
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013640force-tlsv13
13641 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13642 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013643 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013644
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013645generate-certificates
13646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13647 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13648 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13649 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13650 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13651 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13652 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13653 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13654 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13655 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13656 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13657
13658 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13659 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013661 certificate is used many times.
13662
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013663gid <gid>
13664 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13665 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13666 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13667 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13668 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13669
13670group <group>
13671 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13672 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13673 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13674 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13675 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13676
13677id <id>
13678 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13679 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13680 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13681 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13682
13683interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013684 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13685 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13686 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13687 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13688 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13689 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013690 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13691 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13692 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13693 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13694 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13695 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013696
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013697level <level>
13698 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13699 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13700 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013701 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013702 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13703 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13704 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013705 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013706 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013707 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013708 all counters).
13709
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013710severity-output <format>
13711 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13712 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13713 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13714 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13715 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13716 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13717 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13718 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13719 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13720 rfc5424 convention.
13721
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013722maxconn <maxconn>
13723 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13724 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13725 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13726 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13727 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13728 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13729 eat all memory.
13730
13731mode <mode>
13732 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13733 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13734 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13735 UNIX sockets.
13736
13737mss <maxseg>
13738 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13739 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13740 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13741 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13742 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13743 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13744 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13745 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13746 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13747 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13748 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13749
13750name <name>
13751 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13752 page.
13753
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013754namespace <name>
13755 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13756 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13757 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13758 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13759
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013760nice <nice>
13761 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13762 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13763 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13764 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13765 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13766 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13767 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13768 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13769 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13770 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13771 one for an RDP socket.
13772
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013773no-ca-names
13774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13775 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013776 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013777
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013778no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013780 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013781 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013782 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013783 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13784 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013785
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013786no-tls-tickets
13787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13788 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13789 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013790 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13791 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013792 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13793 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13794 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013795
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013796no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013798 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013799 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013800 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013801 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13802 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013803
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013804no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013806 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013807 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013808 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013809 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13810 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013811
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013812no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013814 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013815 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013816 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013817 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13818 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013819
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013820no-tlsv13
13821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13822 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13823 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13824 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013825 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13826 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013827
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013828npn <protocols>
13829 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13830 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13831 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013832 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013833 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013834 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13835 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13836 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13837 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13838 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013839
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013840prefer-client-ciphers
13841 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13842 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13843 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013844 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13845 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13846 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013847
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013848process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013849 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13850 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13851 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13852 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13853 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13854 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013855
13856 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13857
13858 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013859 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13860 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13861 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13862 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13863 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013864
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013865proto <name>
13866 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13867 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13868 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013869 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13870 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13871
13872 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13873 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13874 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13875 also reported (flag=HTX).
13876
13877 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13878 a bind line :
13879
13880 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13881 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13882 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13883
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013884 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013885 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013886 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013887 h2" on the bind line.
13888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013889ssl
13890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013891 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013892 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13893 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013894 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13895 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013896
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013897ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13898 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013899 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13900 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13901 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013902 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13903
13904ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013905 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13906 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13907 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13908 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013909
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013910strict-sni
13911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13912 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13913 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13914 See the "crt" option for more information.
13915
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013916tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013917 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013918 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013919 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013920 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013921 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13922 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13923 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13924 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13925 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13926 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13927 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13928
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013929tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013930 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013931 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13932 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13933 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13934 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13935 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13936 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13937 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013938 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13939 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13940 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013941
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013942tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13943 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013944 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13945 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13946 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13947 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13948 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13949 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13950 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13951 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13952 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13953 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013954 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13955 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13956
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013957transparent
13958 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13959 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13960 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13961 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13962 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13963 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13964 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13965 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13966 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13967 so check for support with your vendor.
13968
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013969v4v6
13970 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13971 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13972 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13973 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013974 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013975
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013976v6only
13977 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13978 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13979 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013980 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13981 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013982
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013983uid <uid>
13984 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13985 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13986 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13987 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13988 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13989
13990user <user>
13991 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13992 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13993 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13994 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13995 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13996
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013997verify [none|optional|required]
13998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13999 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14000 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14001 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14002 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014003 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14004 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14005 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14006 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014009------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014011The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14012which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14013arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14014settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14015after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14016Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14017address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014019 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014020 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014021
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014022Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14023keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014025The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014026
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014027addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014028 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014029 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14030 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14031 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14032 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14033 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014034
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014035agent-check
14036 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014037 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014038 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14039 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14040 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014041
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014042 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014043 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014044 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014045 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14046 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014048 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14049 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14050 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14051 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14052 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014053
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014054 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014055 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014056
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014057 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14058 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14059 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014060
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014061 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14062 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14063 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014064
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014065 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014066 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14067 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14068 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14069 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014071 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014072
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014073 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14074 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014076 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14077 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14078 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14079 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14080 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14081 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14082 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14083 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14084 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014085
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014086 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14087 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014088 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14089 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14090 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014091 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014094 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014095
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014096agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014097 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014098 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14099 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14100 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14101 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14102
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103agent-inter <delay>
14104 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14105 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14106
14107 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14108 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14109 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14110 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14111 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14112 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14113 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14114 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14115 of backends use the same servers.
14116
14117 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14118
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014119agent-addr <addr>
14120 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14121
14122 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014123 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014124 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14125 hostname, it will be resolved.
14126
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014127agent-port <port>
14128 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14129
14130 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14131
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014132allow-0rtt
14133 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014134 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14135 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014136
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014137alpn <protocols>
14138 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14139 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14140 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014141 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014142 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14143 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14144 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14145 now obsolete NPN extension.
14146 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14147 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14148
14149 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014151backup
14152 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14153 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14154 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14155 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014156 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14157 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014158
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014159ca-file <cafile>
14160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14161 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14162 server's certificate.
14163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014164check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014165 This option enables health checks on a server:
14166 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14167 considered available.
14168 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14169 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14170 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14171 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14172 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14173 set.
14174 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14175 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14176 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14177 exchanges succeed.
14178
14179 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14180 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14181 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14182 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14183 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014184 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014185 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14186
14187 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14188 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14189
14190 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14191 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14192
14193 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14194 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14195 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14196 available.
14197
14198 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14199 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14200 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14201
14202 Example:
14203 # simple tcp check
14204 backend foo
14205 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14206 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14207 backend foo
14208 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14209 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14210 backend foo
14211 option tcp-check
14212 tcp-check connect
14213 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014214
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014215check-send-proxy
14216 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14217 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14218 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14219 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14220 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14221 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14222 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14223
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014224check-alpn <protocols>
14225 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14226 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14227 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14228
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014229check-proto <name>
14230 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14231 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14232 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014233 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14234 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14235
14236 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14237 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14238 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14239 also reported (flag=HTX).
14240
14241 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14242 directive on a server line:
14243
14244 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14245 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14246 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14247 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14248
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014249 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014250 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14251 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14252
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014253check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014254 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014255 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14256 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014257
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014258check-ssl
14259 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14260 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14261 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14262 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014263 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014264 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14265 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014266 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014267 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14268 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014269
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014270check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014271 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014272 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14273 for normal traffic.
14274
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014275ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14277 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14278 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014279 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14280 information and recommendations see e.g.
14281 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14282 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14283 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014284
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014285ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14287 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14288 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14289 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014290 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14291 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14292 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014294cookie <value>
14295 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14296 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14297 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14298 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14299 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14300 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14301 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14302
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014303crl-file <crlfile>
14304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14305 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14306 to verify server's certificate.
14307
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014308crt <cert>
14309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14310 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14311 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14312 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14313 certificate request.
14314
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014315 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14316 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14317 option is set accordingly).
14318
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014319disabled
14320 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14321 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14322 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14323 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14324 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014325 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014326
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014327enabled
14328 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14329 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14330 default value.
14331 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14332 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014334error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014335 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14336 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14337 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014339 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014341fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014342 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14343 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14344 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14345
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014346force-sslv3
14347 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14348 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014349 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014350 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014351
14352force-tlsv10
14353 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014354 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014355 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014356
14357force-tlsv11
14358 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014359 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014360 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014361
14362force-tlsv12
14363 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014364 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014365 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014366
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014367force-tlsv13
14368 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14369 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014370 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014372id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014373 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14374 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14375 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014376
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014377init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14378 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14379 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014380 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014381 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14382 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14383 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14384 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14385 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14386 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14387 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14388 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14389 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014390 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014391 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14392 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14393 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14394 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14395 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14396 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014397 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014398
14399 Example:
14400 defaults
14401 # never fail on address resolution
14402 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014404inter <delay>
14405fastinter <delay>
14406downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014407 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14408 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14409 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14410 between checks depending on the server state :
14411
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014412 Server state | Interval used
14413 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14414 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14415 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14416 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14417 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14418 or yet unchecked. |
14419 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14420 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14421 | "inter" otherwise.
14422 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014424 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14425 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14426 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14427 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014428 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14429 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14430 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14431 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14432 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014433
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014434log-proto <logproto>
14435 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14436 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14437 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14438 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014440maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014441 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14442 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014443 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14444 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014445 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14446 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14447 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14448 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14449
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014450 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14451 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14452 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14453 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14454 than 50 concurrent requests.
14455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014456maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014457 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14458 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14459 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14460 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014461 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14462 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14463 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14464 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14465 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14466 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14467 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014468
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014469max-reuse <count>
14470 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14471 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14472 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14473 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14474 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14475 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14476 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14477 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014479minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014480 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14481 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14482 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14483 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14484 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14485 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014486 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014487 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014488
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014489namespace <name>
14490 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14491 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14492 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14493 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14494
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014495no-agent-check
14496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14498 default value.
14499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14500 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14501
14502no-backup
14503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14505 default value.
14506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14507 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14508
14509no-check
14510 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14511 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14512 default value.
14513 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14514 "default-server" "check" setting.
14515
14516no-check-ssl
14517 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14518 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14519 default value.
14520 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14521 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14522
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014523no-send-proxy
14524 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14525 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14526 default value.
14527 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14528 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14529
14530no-send-proxy-v2
14531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14533 default value.
14534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14535 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14536
14537no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14540 default value.
14541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14542 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14543
14544no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14545 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14546 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14547 default value.
14548 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14549 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14550
14551no-ssl
14552 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14553 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14554 default value.
14555 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14556 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14557
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014558 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14559 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14560 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14561
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014562no-ssl-reuse
14563 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14564 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14565 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14566 and for paranoid users.
14567
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014568no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014569 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14570 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014571 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014572
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014573 Supported in default-server: No
14574
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014575no-tls-tickets
14576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14577 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14578 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014579 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14580 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014581 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14582 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14583 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014584 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014585
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014586no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014587 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014588 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14589 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014590 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14591 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014592 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014593
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014594 Supported in default-server: No
14595
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014596no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014597 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014598 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14599 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014600 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14601 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014602 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014603
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014604 Supported in default-server: No
14605
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014606no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014607 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014608 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14609 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014610 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14611 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014612 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014613
14614 Supported in default-server: No
14615
14616no-tlsv13
14617 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14618 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14619 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14620 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14621 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014622 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014623
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014624 Supported in default-server: No
14625
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014626no-verifyhost
14627 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14628 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14629 default value.
14630 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14631 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014632
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014633no-tfo
14634 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14635 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14636 default value.
14637 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14638 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14639
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014640non-stick
14641 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14642 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14643 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14644
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014645npn <protocols>
14646 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14647 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14648 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014649 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014650 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14651 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14652 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014654observe <mode>
14655 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14656 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14657 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14658 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14659 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14660 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014661 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014662
14663 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014665on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014666 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14667 Currently, four modes are available:
14668 - fastinter: force fastinter
14669 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14670 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14671 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14672 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14673
14674 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14675
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014676on-marked-down <action>
14677 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14678 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014679 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14680 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14681 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14682 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14683 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14684 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14685 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14686 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014687
14688 Actions are disabled by default
14689
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014690on-marked-up <action>
14691 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14692 Currently one action is available:
14693 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14694 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14695 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14696 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014697 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14698 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014699 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14700 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14701
14702 Actions are disabled by default
14703
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014704pool-low-conn <max>
14705 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14706 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14707 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14708 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14709 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14710 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14711 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14712 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14713 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14714 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014715 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14716 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14717 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14718 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014719
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014720pool-max-conn <max>
14721 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14722 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14723 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14724 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14725 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14726 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14727
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014728pool-purge-delay <delay>
14729 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014730 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014731 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014733port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014734 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014735 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14736 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14737 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14738 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14739 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014740
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014741proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014742 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14743 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14744 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014745 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14746 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14747
14748 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14749 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14750 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14751 also reported (flag=HTX).
14752
14753 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14754 a server line :
14755
14756 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14757 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14758 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14759 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14760
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014761 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014762 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014764redir <prefix>
14765 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14766 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14767 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14768 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14769 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14770 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14771 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14772 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014773 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014774 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014775 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14776 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14777 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14778 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14779
14780 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014782rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014783 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14784 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14785 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14786
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014787resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14788 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14789 server.
14790
14791 Available options:
14792
14793 * allow-dup-ip
14794 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14795 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14796 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14797 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14798 For such case, simply enable this option.
14799 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14800
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014801 * ignore-weight
14802 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14803 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14804 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14805
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014806 * prevent-dup-ip
14807 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14808 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14809 same fqdn.
14810 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14811
14812 Example:
14813 backend b_myapp
14814 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14815 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14816 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14817
14818 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14819 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14820 it
14821 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14822 different address
14823
14824 Default value: not set
14825
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014826resolve-prefer <family>
14827 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14828 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14829 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14830 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14831
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014832 Default value: ipv6
14833
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014834 Example:
14835
14836 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014837
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014838resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014839 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014840 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014841 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014842 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14843 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014844 configured network, another address is selected.
14845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014846 Example:
14847
14848 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014849
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014850resolvers <id>
14851 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14852 hostname.
14853
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014854 Example:
14855
14856 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014857
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014858 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014859
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014860send-proxy
14861 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14862 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14863 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14864 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014865 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14866 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14867 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14868 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014869 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014870 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14871 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14872 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14873 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14874 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014875 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14876 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014877
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014878send-proxy-v2
14879 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14880 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14881 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14882 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014883 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14884 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14885 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14886 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014887
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014888proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014889 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14890 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14891
14892 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14893 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14894 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14895 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14896 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14897 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14898 connection is supported).
14899 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14900 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14901 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14902 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14903 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14904 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14905 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014906
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014907send-proxy-v2-ssl
14908 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14909 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14910 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14911 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14912 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14913 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14914 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014915 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14916 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014917
14918send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14919 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14920 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14921 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14922 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14923 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14924 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14925 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14926 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014927 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14928 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014930slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014931 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14932 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14933 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14934 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14935 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14936 parameters :
14937
14938 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14939 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14940
14941 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14942 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14943 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14944 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14945
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014946 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014947 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14948 seen as failed.
14949
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014950sni <expression>
14951 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14952 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14953 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14954 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014955 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14956 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014957 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014958 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14959 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014960
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014961source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014962source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014963source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014964 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14965 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14966 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14967 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14968
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014969 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14970 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14971 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14972 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14973 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14974 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14975 server.
14976
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014977 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14978 specifying the source address without port(s).
14979
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014980ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014981 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14982 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14983 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14984 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14985 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14986 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014987 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14988 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014989
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014990ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14991 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14992 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14993 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14994
14995ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14996 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14997 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14998 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14999
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015000ssl-reuse
15001 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15002 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15003 default value.
15004 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15005 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15006
15007stick
15008 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15009 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15010 default value.
15011 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15012 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015013
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015014socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015015 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015016 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15017 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15018
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015019tcp-ut <delay>
15020 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015021 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015022 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015023 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015024 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15025 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15026 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15027 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15028 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15029 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15030 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15031 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15032 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15033
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015034tfo
15035 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15036 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15037 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15038 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015039 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015040 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015042track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015043 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15044 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15045 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15046 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015047 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15048
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015049tls-tickets
15050 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15051 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15052 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015053 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15054 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15055 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015056 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015057 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015058
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015059verify [none|required]
15060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015061 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015062 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15063 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015064 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015065 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15066 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15067 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15068 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15069 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15070 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15071 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15072 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015073
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015074verifyhost <hostname>
15075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015076 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15077 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15078 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15079 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15080 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15081 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15082 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15083 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015085weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015086 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15087 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15088 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015089 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15090 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15091 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15092 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15093 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15094 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015095
15096
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150975.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15098-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015099
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015100HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15101using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015102configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015103This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15104can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15105workload.
15106This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15107resolution at run time.
15108Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15109carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15110
15111
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151125.3.1. Global overview
15113----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015114
15115As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15116different steps of the process life:
15117
15118 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15119 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15120 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15121
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015122 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15123 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015124
15125A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15126 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15127 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15128 resolution to know this new IP.
15129
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015130When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015132SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15133from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015134will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015135will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015136
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015137A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015138 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015139 first valid response.
15140
15141 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15142 servers return an error.
15143
15144
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151455.3.2. The resolvers section
15146----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015147
15148This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015149HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15150contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015151
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015152When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15153uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15154is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15155answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15156
15157When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015158used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015159
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015160 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15161 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15162 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015163
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015164 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15165 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015166
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015167 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15168 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15169 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015170
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015171For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15172following scenarios are possible:
15173
15174 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15175 ignored
15176
15177 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15178 applied
15179
15180 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15181 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15182
15183 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15184 retries the query with a new type
15185
15186 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15187 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015188
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015189As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015190a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015192
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015193
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015194resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015195 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015196
15197A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15198
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015199accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015200 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015201 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015202 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15203 by RFC 6891)
15204
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015205 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15206 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15207 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15208 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15209 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15210 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015211
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015212nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15213 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15214 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15215 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15216 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15217 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15218 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15219 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15220 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15221 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015222 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15223
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015224parse-resolv-conf
15225 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15226 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15227 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15228
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229hold <status> <period>
15230 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15231 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015232 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015233 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015234 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15235 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15236 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15237
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015238 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015239
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015240resolve_retries <nb>
15241 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15242 giving up.
15243 Default value: 3
15244
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015245 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15246 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15247 type.
15248
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015249timeout <event> <time>
15250 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15251 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15252 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015253 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15254 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015255 Default value: 1s
15256 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015257 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015258 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015259 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15260 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15261
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015262 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015263
15264 resolvers mydns
15265 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15266 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015267 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015268 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015269 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015270 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015271 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015272 hold other 30s
15273 hold refused 30s
15274 hold nx 30s
15275 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015276 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015277 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015278
15279
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200152806. Cache
15281---------
15282
15283HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15284(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15285RAM.
15286
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015287The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15288blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015289
15290If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15291independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15292when we try to allocate a new one.
15293
15294The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15295
15296It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15297"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15298for more details.
15299
15300When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15301replaced by "<CACHE>".
15302
15303
153046.1. Limitation
15305----------------
15306
15307The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15308
15309- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015310- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15311 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15312 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015313- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15314- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015315- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15316 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15317 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015318- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15319 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015320- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15321 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15322 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015323
15324- If the request is not a GET
15325- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15326- If the request contains an Authorization header
15327
15328
153296.2. Setup
15330-----------
15331
15332To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15333the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15334
15335
153366.2.1. Cache section
15337---------------------
15338
15339cache <name>
15340 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15341 size of cache is mandatory.
15342
15343total-max-size <megabytes>
15344 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15345 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15346
15347max-object-size <bytes>
15348 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15349 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15350 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15351
15352max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015353 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015354 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15355 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15356 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15357 default.
15358
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015359process-vary <on/off>
15360 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015361 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15362 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15363 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015364 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015365
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015366max-secondary-entries <number>
15367 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15368 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15369 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015371
153726.2.2. Proxy section
15373---------------------
15374
15375http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15376 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15377 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15378 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15379 after this one.
15380
15381http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15382 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15383 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15384 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15385 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15386
15387
15388Example:
15389
15390 backend bck1
15391 mode http
15392
15393 http-request cache-use foobar
15394 http-response cache-store foobar
15395 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15396
15397 cache foobar
15398 total-max-size 4
15399 max-age 240
15400
15401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154027. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15403----------------------------------
15404
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015406client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15407The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15408these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15409but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15410data called patterns.
15411
15412
154137.1. ACL basics
15414---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015415
15416The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15417content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15418from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15419simple :
15420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015422 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15424 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015426The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15427adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015428
15429In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015432
15433This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15434Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15435and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015436an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15437conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15438as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15439are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015440
15441ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15442'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15443which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15444
15445There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15446performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15449specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15450this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015451methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15452ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453
15454Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15455 - boolean
15456 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15457 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15458 - string
15459 - data block
15460
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015461Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15462converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15463would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15464The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15465which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15466
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015467Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15468keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15469fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15470which are summarized in the table below :
15471
15472 +---------------------+-----------------+
15473 | Sample or converter | Default |
15474 | output type | matching method |
15475 +---------------------+-----------------+
15476 | boolean | bool |
15477 +---------------------+-----------------+
15478 | integer | int |
15479 +---------------------+-----------------+
15480 | ip | ip |
15481 +---------------------+-----------------+
15482 | string | str |
15483 +---------------------+-----------------+
15484 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15485 +---------------------+-----------------+
15486
15487Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15488matching method, see below.
15489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15491 - boolean
15492 - integer or integer range
15493 - IP address / network
15494 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15495 - regular expression
15496 - hex block
15497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015498The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15499
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015500 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15501 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015503 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015504 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015505 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015506 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15509read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15510if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15511lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15512will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15513beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015514a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15516exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15517
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015518The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15519parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15520ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15521a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15522check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15523
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015524The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15525socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15526file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15529loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15530
15531 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15532
15533In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15534the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15535case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15536as well.
15537
15538The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15539sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15540do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15541methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15542is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015543obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15545default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15546that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15547string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15548
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015549The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15550By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15551string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15552resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015553server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015554waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015555flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15556function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15559sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15560be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015561
15562 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15563 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15565 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15566 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15567 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015568
15569 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15570 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015572
15573 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015575
15576 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015578
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015579 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015580 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15581
15582 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15583 binary or string samples.
15584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15586 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15589 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15590 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15593 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15596 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15599 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15602 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015603 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15606 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15607 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015608
15609For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15610request, it is possible to do :
15611
15612 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15613
15614In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15615buffer, one would use the following acl :
15616
15617 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015619On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15620possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15621
15622 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15625criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15626method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15627to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15628criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15629the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015632the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15633For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15636 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15637 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15638 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015639
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015640
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015641The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15642types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15643combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15644brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15645default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 +-------------------------------------------------+
15648 | Input sample type |
15649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015650 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15652 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015654 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015656 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015658 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015660 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015662 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015664 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015666 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015668 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015670 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015672 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015674 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15676 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15677 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015678
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156807.1.1. Matching booleans
15681------------------------
15682
15683In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15684Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15685When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15686that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15687
15688Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15689return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15690"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156937.1.2. Matching integers
15694------------------------
15695
15696Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15697enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15698to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15699
15700Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15701matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15702lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015703
15704For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15705unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15706representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15707
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015708As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15709two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15710instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15711ranges and operators.
15712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015713For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015714operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15715Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15716of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015718Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015719
15720 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15721 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15722 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15723 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15724 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015726For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015727
15728 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15729
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015730This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15731
15732 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157357.1.3. Matching strings
15736-----------------------
15737
15738String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15739different forms :
15740
15741 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015742 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743
15744 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015745 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746
15747 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15748 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15749
15750 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15751 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15752
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015753 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15755 matches.
15756
15757 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15758 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15759 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015760
15761String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15762exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15763characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15764string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15765to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015766before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015767
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015768Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15769(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15770Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15771
15772Example:
15773 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15774 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157777.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15778---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015779
15780Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15781they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15782possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15783passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15784the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015785the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15786match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015787
15788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157897.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15790-------------------------------------
15791
15792It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15793not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15794a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15795to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15796digits may be used upper or lower case.
15797
15798Example :
15799 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15800 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15801
15802
158037.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15804---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015805
15806IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15807netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15808within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015809host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015810difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15811at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15812does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15813parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015814
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015815The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15816abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15817
15818 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15819 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15820 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15821 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15822 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15823 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15824 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15825 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15826
15827Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15828192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15829
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015830IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15831Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15832trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15833IPv6 patterns.
15834
15835HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15836following situations :
15837 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15838 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15839 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15840 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15841 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15842 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15843 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15844 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15845 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15846 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848
158497.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15850----------------------------------
15851
15852Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15853combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15854
15855 - AND (implicit)
15856 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15857 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15864indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15867"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15868requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15869is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15870
15871 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015872 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15873 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15874 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875
15876To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15877and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15878
15879 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15880 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15881 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15882 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015884 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15886 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15887 use_backend www if host_www
15888
15889It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15890expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15891be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15892the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15893
15894 The following rule :
15895
15896 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015897 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898
15899 Can also be written that way :
15900
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015901 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902
15903It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15904to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15905simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15906sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15907good use is the following :
15908
15909 With named ACLs :
15910
15911 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15912 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15913 monitor fail if site_dead
15914
15915 With anonymous ACLs :
15916
15917 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15918
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015919See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15920keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921
15922
159237.3. Fetching samples
15924---------------------
15925
15926Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15927against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15928sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15929ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15930of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15931available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15932
15933This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15934Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15935compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15936deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15937
15938The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15939matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15940method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15941indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15942
15943As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15944when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15945mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15946the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15947ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15948
15949Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15950multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15951when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015952incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15953are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15955all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15956
15957Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15958 - name
15959 - name(arg1)
15960 - name(arg1,arg2)
15961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015962
159637.3.1. Converters
15964-----------------
15965
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015966Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15967of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15968is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15969was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015970has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015971unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15972
15973These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15974sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15975the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015976support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015977
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015978A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15979support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15980supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15981(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15982bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015985
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001598651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15987 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15988 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15989 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15990 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15991 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15992
15993 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015994 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15995 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015996 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15997 frontend http-in
15998 bind *:8081
15999 default_backend servers
16000 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16001 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016003add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016004 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016005 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016006 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16007 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016008 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016009 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16010 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016014 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016015
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016016aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16017 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16018 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16019 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16020 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16021 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16022 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16023
16024 Example:
16025 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16026 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16027
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016028and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016029 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016030 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016031 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16032 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016033 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016034 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16035 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16036 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16037 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016038 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016039 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016040
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016041b64dec
16042 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16043 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016044 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16045 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016046
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016047base64
16048 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016049 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016050 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16051 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016052
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016053bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016054 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016055 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016056 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016057 presence of a flag).
16058
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016059bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16060 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16061 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016062 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016063
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016064concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16065 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16066 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16067 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16068 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16069 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16070 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16071 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16072 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16073 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16074 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016075 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016076 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016077 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16078 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016079
16080 Example:
16081 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16082 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16083 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016084 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016085 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16086
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016087cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016088 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16089 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016090
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016091crc32([<avalanche>])
16092 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16093 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16094 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16095 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16096 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16097 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16098 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16099 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16100 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16101 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016102 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16103
16104crc32c([<avalanche>])
16105 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16106 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16107 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16108 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16109 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16110 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16111 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16112 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016113
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016114cut_crlf
16115 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16116 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16117 updated.
16118
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016119da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016120 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16121 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16122 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16123 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016124 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016125 configuration language.
16126
16127 Example:
16128 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016129 bind *:8881
16130 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016131 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016132
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016133debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16134 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16135 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16136 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16137 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16138 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16139 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16140 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16141 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16142 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16143 printable sample types.
16144
16145 Example:
16146 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016147
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016148digest(<algorithm>)
16149 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16150 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016152 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016153 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16154
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016155div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016156 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16157 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016158 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016159 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16160 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016161 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016162 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16163 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16164 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16165 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016166 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016167 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016168
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016169djb2([<avalanche>])
16170 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16171 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16172 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16173 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16174 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16175 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16176 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016177 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16178 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016179
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016180even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016181 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016182 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16183
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016184field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16185 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16186 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16187 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16188 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16189 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16190 fields.
16191
16192 Example :
16193 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16194 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16195 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16196 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16197 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016198
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016199fix_is_valid
16200 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16201 Information eXchange):
16202
16203 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16204 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016205 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016206 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016207 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016208 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16209 checksum
16210
16211 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16212 the server can be parsed.
16213
16214 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16215 message, false if not.
16216
16217 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16218
16219 Example:
16220 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16221 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16222
16223fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16224 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16225 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16226 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16227 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016228 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016229 added.
16230
16231 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16232 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16233 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16234 fix_is_valid converter.
16235
16236 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16237
16238 Example:
16239 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16240 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16241 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16242 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16243 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16244
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016245hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016247 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016249 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016250
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016251hex2i
16252 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016253 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016254
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016255htonl
16256 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16257 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16258 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16259 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16260
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016261hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016262 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16263 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16264 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16265 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16266
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016267 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016268 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16269
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016270http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016271 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16272 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016273 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16274 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16275 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16276 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16277 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16278 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16279 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16280 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016282iif(<true>,<false>)
16283 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16284 string otherwise.
16285
16286 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016287 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016288
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016289in_table(<table>)
16290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16292 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016293 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016294 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16295
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016296ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016297 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016298 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016299 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16300 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16301 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16302 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16303 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016304
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016305json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016306 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016307 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016308 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016309 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16310 of errors:
16311 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16312 bytes, ...)
16313 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16314 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16315
16316 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16317 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16318 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16319 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16320 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16321 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016322 - "ascii" : never fails;
16323 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16324 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016325 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016327 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16328 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16329
16330 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016331 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016332
16333 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016334 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016335 capture request header user-agent len 150
16336 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016337
16338 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16339 GET / HTTP/1.0
16340 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16341
16342 Output log:
16343 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16344
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016345json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16346 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16347 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16348 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16349 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16350
16351 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16352 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16353
16354 Example:
16355 # get a integer value from the request body
16356 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16357 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16358
16359 # get a key with '.' in the name
16360 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16361 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16362
16363 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16364 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16365
16366 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16367 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16368
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016369language(<value>[,<default>])
16370 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16371 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16372 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16373 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16374 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16375 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16376 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16377 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16378 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016379 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016380 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16381 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016382
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016383 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016384
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016385 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16386 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016388 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16389 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16390 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16391 use_backend spanish if es
16392 use_backend french if fr
16393 use_backend english if en
16394 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016395
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016396length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016397 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16398 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16399 type. The result is of type integer.
16400
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016401lower
16402 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16403 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16404 type. The result is of type string.
16405
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016406ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16407 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16408 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16409 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16410 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16411 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16412 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16413
16414 Example :
16415
16416 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016417 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016418 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16419
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016420ltrim(<chars>)
16421 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16422 representation of the input sample.
16423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016424map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16425map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16426map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16427 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16428 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16429 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16430 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16431 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16432 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16433 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16434 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016435
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016436 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16437 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16438 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016439
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016440 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016441 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016443 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16444 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16445 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16446 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016447 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16448 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016449 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16450 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16451 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16452 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16453 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16454 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16455 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16456 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016457 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16458 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16459 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016460 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16461 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16462 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16463 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16464 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016465
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016466 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16467 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16468 the corresponding match text.
16469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016470 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16471 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16472 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16473 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16474 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016476 Example :
16477
16478 # this is a comment and is ignored
16479 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16480 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16481 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16482 | | | `---------- value
16483 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16484 | `---------------------------- key
16485 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16486
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016487mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016488 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16489 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016490 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016491 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016492 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016493 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16494 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16495 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16496 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016498 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016499
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016500mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016501 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16502 <packettype>.
16503 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16504 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16505 from.
16506 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16507 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16508 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16509
16510 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16511 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16512 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16513 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16514
16515 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16516 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16517 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16518 packets only):
16519 17: Session Expiry Interval
16520 33: Receive Maximum
16521 39: Maximum Packet Size
16522 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16523 25: Request Response Information
16524 23: Request Problem Information
16525 21: Authentication Method
16526 22: Authentication Data
16527 18: Will Delay Interval
16528 1: Payload Format Indicator
16529 2: Message Expiry Interval
16530 3: Content Type
16531 8: Response Topic
16532 9: Correlation Data
16533 Not supported yet:
16534 38: User Property
16535
16536 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16537 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16538 packets only):
16539 17: Session Expiry Interval
16540 33: Receive Maximum
16541 36: Maximum QoS
16542 37: Retain Available
16543 39: Maximum Packet Size
16544 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16545 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16546 31: Reason String
16547 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16548 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16549 42: Shared Subscription Available
16550 19: Server Keep Alive
16551 26: Response Information
16552 28: Server Reference
16553 21: Authentication Method
16554 22: Authentication Data
16555 Not supported yet:
16556 38: User Property
16557
16558 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16559 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16560 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16561 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16562
16563 Example:
16564
16565 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16566 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16567 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16568 if data_in_buffer
16569 # do the same as above
16570 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16571 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16572 if data_in_buffer
16573
16574mqtt_is_valid
16575 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16576
16577 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16578 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16579 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16580 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16581
16582 Example:
16583
16584 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016585 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016586
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016587mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016588 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016589 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16590 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016591 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016592 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16596 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16597 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016598 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016599 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016600
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016601nbsrv
16602 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16603 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16604 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16605 map lookup.
16606
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016607neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016608 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16609 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16610 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16611 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016612
16613not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016614 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016615 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016616 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016617 absence of a flag).
16618
16619odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016620 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016621 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16622
16623or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016624 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016625 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016626 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16627 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16630 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16631 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16632 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016633 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016634 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016635
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016636protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16637 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16638 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16639 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16640 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16641 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16642 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16643 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16644 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16645 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16646 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16647 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16648
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016649regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016650 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16651 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16652 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16653 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16654 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16655 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16656 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16657 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16658 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016659 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16660 of characters with other ones.
16661
16662 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16663 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16664 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16665 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16666 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16667 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016668
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016669 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016670
16671 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16672 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16673 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016674 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016675
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016676 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16677 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16678
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016679 # capture groups and backreferences
16680 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016681 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016682 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16683
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016684capture-req(<id>)
16685 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16686 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16687
16688 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016689 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16690 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016691
16692capture-res(<id>)
16693 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16694 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16695
16696 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016697 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16698 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016699
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016700rtrim(<chars>)
16701 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16702 of the input sample.
16703
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016704sdbm([<avalanche>])
16705 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16706 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16707 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16708 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16709 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16710 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16711 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016712 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16713 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016714
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016715secure_memcmp(<var>)
16716 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16717 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16718 match.
16719
16720 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16721 performed in constant time.
16722
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016723 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016724 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16725
16726 Example :
16727
16728 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16729 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16730 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16731 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16732
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016733set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16735 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16736 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16739 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016740 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016744 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016745
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016746sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016747 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016748 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16749
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016750sha2([<bits>])
16751 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16752 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16753
16754 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16755 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16756
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016757 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016758 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16759
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016760srv_queue
16761 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16762 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16763 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16764 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16765 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16766
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016767strcmp(<var>)
16768 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16769 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16770 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16771 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16772 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16773 shorter).
16774
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016775 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16776 strings in constant time.
16777
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016778 Example :
16779
16780 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16781 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16782 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16783
16784
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016785sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016786 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16787 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016788 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016789 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16790 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016791 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016792 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16793 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016794 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016795 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16796 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016797 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016798 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016799
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016800table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16804 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16805 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16806 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16807
16808
16809table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16812 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16813 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16814 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16815 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16816
16817table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016821 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16822 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16823
16824table_conn_cur(<table>)
16825 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16826 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16827 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16828 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16829 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16830
16831table_conn_rate(<table>)
16832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16835 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16836 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16837
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016838table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16841 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16842 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16843 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16844 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16845 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16846 data-type).
16847 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16848
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016849table_gpt0(<table>)
16850 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16851 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16852 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16853 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16854 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16855
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016856table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16860 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16861 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16862 between 0 and 99.
16863 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16864 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16865 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16866 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16867
16868table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16872 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16873 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16874 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16875 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16876 value 0.
16877 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16878 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16879 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16880
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016881table_gpc0(<table>)
16882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16884 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16885 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16886 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16887
16888table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16892 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16893 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16894 sample fetch keyword.
16895
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016896table_gpc1(<table>)
16897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16900 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16901 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16902
16903table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16907 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16908 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16909 sample fetch keyword.
16910
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016911table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16912 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16913 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016914 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016915 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16916 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16917
16918table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16921 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16922 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16923 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16924 keyword.
16925
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016926table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16930 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16931 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16932
16933table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16936 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16937 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16938 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16939 keyword.
16940
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016941table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16942 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16943 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016944 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016945 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16946 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16947
16948table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16949 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16950 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16951 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16952 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16953 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16954 keyword.
16955
16956table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16957 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16958 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016959 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016960 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16961 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16962 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16963 keyword.
16964
16965table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16966 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16967 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016968 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016969 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16970 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16971 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16972 keyword.
16973
16974table_server_id(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16978 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16979 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16980 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16981
16982table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016986 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16987 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16988 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16989 keyword.
16990
16991table_sess_rate(<table>)
16992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16995 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16996 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16997 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16998 keyword.
16999
17000table_trackers(<table>)
17001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17004 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17005 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17006 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17007 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17008 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17009 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17010 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17011
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017012ub64dec
17013 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17014 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17015 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17016
17017 Example:
17018 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17019 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17020
17021ub64enc
17022 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17023
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017024upper
17025 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17026 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17027 type. The result is of type string.
17028
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017029url_dec([<in_form>])
17030 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17031 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17032 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17033 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17034 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17035 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017036
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017037url_enc([<enc_type>])
17038 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17039 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17040 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17041 optional argument is here for future changes.
17042
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017043ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017044 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017045 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17046 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17047 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017048 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17049 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17050 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17051 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017052 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017053 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17054 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017055
17056 Example:
17057 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17058 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17059
17060 message Point {
17061 int32 latitude = 1;
17062 int32 longitude = 2;
17063 }
17064
17065 message PPoint {
17066 Point point = 59;
17067 }
17068
17069 message Rectangle {
17070 // One corner of the rectangle.
17071 PPoint lo = 48;
17072 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17073 PPoint hi = 49;
17074 }
17075
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017076 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17077 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17078 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017079
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017080 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17081 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017082 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017083 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17084
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017085 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017086
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017087 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017088
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017089 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17090 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17091 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017092
17093 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17094 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17095 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17096
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017097 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17098 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17099 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017100
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017101
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017102unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017103 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17104 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17105 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17106 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17107 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17108 response),
17109 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17110 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17112 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17113
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017114utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17115 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17116 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17117 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17118 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17119 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17120 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17121
17122 Example :
17123
17124 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017125 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017126 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17127
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017128word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17129 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17130 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17131 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017132 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017133 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17134 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17135
17136 Example :
17137 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17138 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17139 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17140 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17141 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017142 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017143
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017144wt6([<avalanche>])
17145 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17146 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17147 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17148 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17149 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17150 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17151 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017152 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17153 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017154
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017155xor(<value>)
17156 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017157 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017158 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017159 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017160 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017161 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17162 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017163 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017164 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17165 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017166 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017167 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017168
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017169xxh3([<seed>])
17170 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17171 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17172 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17173 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17174 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17175 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17176 considered as cryptographically secure.
17177
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017178xxh32([<seed>])
17179 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17180 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17181 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17182 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17183 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17184 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17185 as cryptographically secure.
17186
17187xxh64([<seed>])
17188 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17189 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17190 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17191 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17192 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17193 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17194 as cryptographically secure.
17195
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017196
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171977.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017198--------------------------------------------
17199
17200A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17201not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17202"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17203The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17204
17205always_false : boolean
17206 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17207 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17208
17209always_true : boolean
17210 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17211 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17212
17213avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017214 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017215 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17216 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17217 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17218 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17219 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17220 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17221 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17222 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17223 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17224 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17225 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17226 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17227 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017230 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17231 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17232 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17233 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017234 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17235
17236be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17237 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17238 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17239 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17240 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17241 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017242 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17243 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017244
17245 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17246 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17247 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17251 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17252 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017253 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17255 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017256
17257 Example :
17258 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17259 backend dynamic
17260 mode http
17261 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17262 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017263
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017265 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17266 of the string.
17267
17268bool(<bool>) : bool
17269 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17270 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017274 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17276 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017277
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017278 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017279 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017280 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017282 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17283 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017284
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017285 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017286 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017288 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017289 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017291 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017292
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017293 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17294 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017295 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017296 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017297
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017298cpu_calls : integer
17299 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17300 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17301 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17302 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17303 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17304 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17305
17306cpu_ns_avg : integer
17307 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17308 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17309 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17310 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17311 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17312 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17313 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17314 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17315 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17316 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17317 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17318
17319cpu_ns_tot : integer
17320 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17321 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17322 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17323 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17324 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17325 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17326 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17327 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17328 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17329 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17330 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17331 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17332 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17333
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017334date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017335 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017336
17337 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17338 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17339 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017340 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17341
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017342 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17343 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17344 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17345 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17346 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17347
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017348 Example :
17349
17350 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17351 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017352
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017353 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17354 # millisecond granularity
17355 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17356
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017357date_us : integer
17358 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17359 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17360 from the same timeval structure.
17361
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017362distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17363 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17364 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17365 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17366 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017367 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017368 list of supported tokens.
17369
17370distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17371 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17372 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17373 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17374 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017375 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017376 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17377 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17378 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17379 supported tokens.
17380
17381 Example :
17382 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17383 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17384 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17385 # send large files to the big farm
17386 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17387
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017388env(<name>) : string
17389 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17390 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17391 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17392 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17393 certain way.
17394
17395 Examples :
17396 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17397 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17398
17399 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17400 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17403 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017404 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17405 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17407 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017408 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17410 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017411
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017412fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17413 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17414 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17415 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17418 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17419 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17420 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17421 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17422 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17423 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17424 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17425 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017426
17427 Example :
17428 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17429 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17430 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17431 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17432 frontend mail
17433 bind :25
17434 mode tcp
17435 maxconn 100
17436 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17437 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17438 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17439 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017440
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017441hostname : string
17442 Returns the system hostname.
17443
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017444int(<integer>) : signed integer
17445 Returns a signed integer.
17446
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017447ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17448 Returns an ipv4.
17449
17450ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17451 Returns an ipv6.
17452
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017453lat_ns_avg : integer
17454 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17455 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17456 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17457 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17458 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17459 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17460 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17461 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17462 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017463 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17464 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17465 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17466 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17467 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17468 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017469
17470lat_ns_tot : integer
17471 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17472 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17473 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17474 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17475 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17476 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17477 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17478 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17479 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017480 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17481 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17482 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17483 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17484 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017485 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17486 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17487 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17488 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17489 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17490 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17491
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017492meth(<method>) : method
17493 Returns a method.
17494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17497 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17498 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017499 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17500 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17501 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017502
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017503prio_class : integer
17504 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17505 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17506 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17507
17508prio_offset : integer
17509 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17510 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17511 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17512 set-priority-offset".
17513
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017514proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017515 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17516 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017518queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017519 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17520 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17521 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017522 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17523 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17524 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17525 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17526 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17527
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017528rand([<range>]) : integer
17529 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17530 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17531 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17532 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17533 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17537 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17538 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17539 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17540 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017541 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17542 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17543
17544srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17545 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17546 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17547 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17548 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17549 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17550 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17551 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17552
17553 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17554 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555
17556srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17557 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17558 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17559 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017560 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17562 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17563 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17564
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017565srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17567 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17568 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17569 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17570 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17571 fetch methods.
17572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17574 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17575 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017576 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17578 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017579 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580 overloading servers).
17581
17582 Example :
17583 # Redirect to a separate back
17584 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17585 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17586 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17587
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017588srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017589 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17590 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17591 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17592
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017593srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017594 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17595 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17596 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17597
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017598srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017599 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17600 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17601 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17602
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017603stopping : boolean
17604 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17605 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17606 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17607
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017608str(<string>) : string
17609 Returns a string.
17610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17612 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17613 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17614
17615table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17616 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17617 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17618 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17619
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017620thread : integer
17621 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17622 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17623 and debugging purposes.
17624
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017625uuid([<version>]) : string
17626 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17627 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17628 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17629
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017630var(<var-name>) : undefined
17631 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017632 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17633 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017634 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017635 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17636 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017637 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017638 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17639 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017641 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017642
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644----------------------------------
17645
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017646The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17648methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17649sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17650TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017651the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17652counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017653"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17654used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17655can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17656Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17657table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17658tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17659currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017661bc_dst : ip
17662 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17663 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17664 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17665 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17666
17667bc_dst_port : integer
17668 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017669 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017670
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017671bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017672 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17673 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17674 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17675
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017676bc_src : ip
17677 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017678 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017679 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17680 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17681
17682bc_src_port : integer
17683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017684 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017686be_id : integer
17687 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017688 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17689 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017690
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017691be_name : string
17692 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017693 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17694 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017695
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017696be_server_timeout : integer
17697 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17698 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17699 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17700
17701be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17702 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17703 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17704 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17705
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017706cur_server_timeout : integer
17707 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17708 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17709 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17710
17711cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17712 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17713 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17714 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716dst : ip
17717 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17718 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17719 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17720 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017721 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17722 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17723 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17724 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17725 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17726 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727
17728dst_conn : integer
17729 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17730 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17731 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17732 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17733 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17734 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17735 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17736 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017737
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017738dst_is_local : boolean
17739 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17740 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17741 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17742 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017743 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017744 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17745 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17746 it only once per connection.
17747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748dst_port : integer
17749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17750 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17751 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17752 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17753 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17754 an HTTP header.
17755
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017756fc_conn_err : integer
17757 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17758 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17759 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
17760 decribed in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
17761 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17762
17763fc_conn_err_str : string
17764 Returns an error message decribing what problem happened on the current
17765 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17766 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17767 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17768
17769 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17770 | ID | message |
17771 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17772 | 0 | "Success" |
17773 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17774 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17775 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17776 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17777 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17778 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17779 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17780 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17781 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17782 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17783 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17784 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17785 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17786 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17787 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17788 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17789 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17790 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17791 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17792 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17793 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17794 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17795 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17796 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17797 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17798 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17799 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17800 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17801 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17802 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17803 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17804 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17805 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17806 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17807 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17808 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17809 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17810 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17811 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17812 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17813 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17814 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17815 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17816
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017817fc_http_major : integer
17818 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17819 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17820 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17821
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017822fc_pp_authority : string
17823 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17824 if any.
17825
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017826fc_pp_unique_id : string
17827 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17828 if any.
17829
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017830fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17831 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17832 header.
17833
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017834fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17835 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17836 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17837 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17838 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17839 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17840 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17841
17842fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17843 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17844 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17845 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17846 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17847 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17848 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17849
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017850fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017851 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17852 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17853 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17854 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17855
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017856fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017857 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17858 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17859 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17860 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17861
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017862fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017863 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17864 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17865 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17866 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17867
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017868fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017869 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17870 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17871 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17872 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17873
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017874fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017875 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17876 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17877 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17878 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17879
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017880fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017881 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17882 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17883 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17884 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17885
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017886fe_defbe : string
17887 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17888 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890fe_id : integer
17891 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017892 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017893 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17894
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017895fe_name : string
17896 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17897 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17898 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17899
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017900fe_client_timeout : integer
17901 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17902 current frontend.
17903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017904sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017905sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17906sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17907sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017908 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17909 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17910 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017912sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017913sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17914sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17915sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017916 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17917 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17918 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17919
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017920sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17921 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
17922 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
17923 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
17924 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17925 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17926 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
17927 will always return zero.
17928 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17929 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017931sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017932sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17933sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17934sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017935 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17936 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017937 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17938 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17939 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017940
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017941 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017942 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17943 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017944 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17945 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17946 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017947 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17948 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17949
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017950sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17951sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17952sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17953sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17954 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17955 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17956 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17957 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17958 when a first ACL was verified.
17959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017960sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017961sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17962sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17963sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017964 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017965 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017967sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017968sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17969sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17970sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017971 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17972 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17973 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017975sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017976sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17977sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17978sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017979 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17980 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17981 See also src_conn_rate.
17982
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017983sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17984 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
17985 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
17986 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
17987 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17988 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
17989 index, zero is returned.
17990 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17991 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
17992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017993sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017994sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17995sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17996sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017997 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017998 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017999
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018000sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18001sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18002sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18003sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18004 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18005 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18006
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018007sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18008 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18009 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18010 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18011 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18012 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18013 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18014 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18015
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018016sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18017sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18018sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18019sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18020 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18021 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18022
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018023sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18024 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18025 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18026 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18027 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18028 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18029 between 0 and 2.
18030 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18031 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18032 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18033 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18034 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018036sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018037sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18039sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018040 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18041 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18042 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018043 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18044 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18045 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018047sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18048sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18049sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18050sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18051 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18052 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18053 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18054 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18055 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18056 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18057
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018058sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018059sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18060sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18061sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018062 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018063 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18064 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018066sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018067sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18068sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18069sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018070 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18071 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18072 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18073 src_http_err_rate.
18074
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018075sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18076sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18077sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18078sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18079 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18080 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18081 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18082
18083sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18084sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18085sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18086sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18087 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18088 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18089 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18090 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018092sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018093sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18094sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18095sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018096 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018097 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18098 src_http_req_cnt.
18099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018100sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018101sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18102sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18103sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018104 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18105 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18106 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18107 src_http_req_rate.
18108
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018109sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18110 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18111 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18112 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18113 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18114 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18115 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18116 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18117 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18118 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18119
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018120sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018121sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18122sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18123sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018124 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018125 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18126 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18127 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18128 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018129
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018130 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018131 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18132 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018133 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18134
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018135sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18136sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18137sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18138sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18139 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18140 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18141 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18142 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18143 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18144
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018145sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018146sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18147sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18148sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018149 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18150 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18151 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018152
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018153sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018154sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18155sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18156sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018157 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18158 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18159 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018161sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018162sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18163sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18164sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018165 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018166 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18167 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18168 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018169 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018170 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018172sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018173sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018176 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18177 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18178 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18179 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18180 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018181 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018182
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018183sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018184sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18185sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18186sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018187 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18188 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18189 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018191sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018192sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18193sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18194sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018195 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18196 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018197 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018198 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18199 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18201 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18202 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204so_id : integer
18205 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18206 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18207 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018208
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018209so_name : string
18210 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18211 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18212 strings instead of integers.
18213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018215 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018216 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18217 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18218 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018219 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18220 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18221 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018222 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18223 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18224 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18225 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18226 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18227 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18228 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018230 Example:
18231 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18232 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18235 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18236 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18237 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018238 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18241 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18242 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018243 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018244 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018245
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018246src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18247 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18248 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18249 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18250 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18251 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18252 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18253 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18254 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18257 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18258 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18259 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18260 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18261 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18262 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018263
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018264 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018265 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18266 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18267 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18268 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018269 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018270 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18271 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018273src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18274 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18275 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18276 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18277 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18278 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18279 was verified.
18280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018282 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018283 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018284 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018285 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018288 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18290 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018291 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18294 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18295 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18296 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018297 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018298
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018299src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18300 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18301 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18302 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18303 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18304 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18305 is returned.
18306 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18307 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18308 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018311 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018312 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018313 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018314 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018315
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018316src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18317 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18318 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18319 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18320 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18321
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018322src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18323 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18324 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18325 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18326 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18327 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18328 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18329
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018330src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18331 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18332 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18333 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18334 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18335
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018336src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18337 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18338 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18339 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18340 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18341 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18342 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18343 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18344 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18345 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18346 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018349 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018351 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18352 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018353 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18354 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18355 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018356
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018357src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18358 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18359 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18360 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18361 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18362 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18363 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18364 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018367 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018369 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018370 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18374 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18375 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18376 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18377 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018378 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018379
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018380src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18381 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18382 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018383 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018384 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18385 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18386
18387src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18388 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18389 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18390 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18391 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18392 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18393 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018396 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18398 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018399 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18402 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18403 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18404 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018405 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018406 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018407
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018408src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18409 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18410 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18411 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18412 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18413 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18414 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18415 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18416 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18419 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18420 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18421 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018422 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18424 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018425
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018426 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018427 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018428 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018429 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018430
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018431src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18432 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18433 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18434 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18435 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18436 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18437 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18438
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018439src_is_local : boolean
18440 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18441 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18442 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18443 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018444 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018445 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18446 once per connection.
18447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018448src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018449 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18450 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18451 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18452 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18453 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018455src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018456 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18457 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18458 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18459 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18460 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462src_port : integer
18463 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18464 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18465 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18466 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018468src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018469 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018470 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18471 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18472 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018473 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018475src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18476 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18477 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18478 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18479 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018480 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18483 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18484 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18485 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18486 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18487 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18488 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18489 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18490 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018491
18492 Example :
18493 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18494 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18495 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18496 listen ssh
18497 bind :22
18498 mode tcp
18499 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018500 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018501 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018502 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018504srv_id : integer
18505 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18506 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018507 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018508
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018509srv_name : string
18510 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18511 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018512 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185147.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018517The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18519when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18520usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018521future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018522
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001852351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18524 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18525 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18526 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18527 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18528 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18529
18530 Example :
18531 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18532 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18533 # the request.
18534 frontend http-in
18535 bind *:8081
18536 default_backend servers
18537 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18538 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18539
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018540ssl_bc : boolean
18541 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18542 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018543 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18544 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018545
18546ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18547 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018548 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18549 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018550
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018551ssl_bc_alpn : string
18552 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18553 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018554 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018555 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18556 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18557 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18558 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18559 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018560 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18561 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018562
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018563ssl_bc_cipher : string
18564 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018565 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18566 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018567
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018568ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18569 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18570 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18571 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018572 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018573
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018574ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18575 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18576 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018577 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18578 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018579
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018580ssl_bc_npn : string
18581 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18582 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018583 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018584 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18585 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18586 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18587 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018588 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18589 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018590
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018591ssl_bc_protocol : string
18592 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018593 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18594 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018595
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018596ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018597 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018598 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018599 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18600 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018601
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018602ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18603 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18604 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18605 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018606 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018607
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018608ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18609 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18610 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018611 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18612 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018613
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018614ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18615 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18616 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18617 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018618 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018619
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018620ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18621 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018622 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18623 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18627 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18628 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18629 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18630 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18633 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18634 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18635 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18636 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018637
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018638ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018639 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18640 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18641 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018642 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018643 does not support resumed sessions.
18644
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018645ssl_c_der : binary
18646 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18647 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18648 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650ssl_c_err : integer
18651 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18652 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18653 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18654 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18655 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018656
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018657ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18659 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18660 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18661 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18662 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18663 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18664 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18665 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018666 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18667 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18668 LDAP v3.
18669 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18670 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672ssl_c_key_alg : string
18673 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18674 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18675 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018677ssl_c_notafter : string
18678 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18679 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18680 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018682ssl_c_notbefore : string
18683 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18684 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18685 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018686
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018687ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18689 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18690 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18691 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18692 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18693 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18694 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18695 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018696 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18697 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18698 LDAP v3.
18699 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18700 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702ssl_c_serial : binary
18703 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18704 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18705 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18708 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18709 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18710 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018711 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18712 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18713
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018714 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018715 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18718 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18719 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18720 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722ssl_c_used : boolean
18723 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18724 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018726ssl_c_verify : integer
18727 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18728 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18729 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18730 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732ssl_c_version : integer
18733 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18734 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018735
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018736ssl_f_der : binary
18737 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18738 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18739 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18740
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018741ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18743 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18744 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18745 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018746 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18748 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18749 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018750 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18751 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18752 LDAP v3.
18753 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18754 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018756ssl_f_key_alg : string
18757 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18758 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18759 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761ssl_f_notafter : string
18762 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18763 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18764 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018766ssl_f_notbefore : string
18767 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18768 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18769 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018770
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018771ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18773 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18774 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18775 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18776 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18777 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18778 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18779 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018780 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18781 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18782 LDAP v3.
18783 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18784 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786ssl_f_serial : binary
18787 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18788 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18789 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018790
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018791ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18792 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18793 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18794 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018796ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18797 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18798 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18799 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801ssl_f_version : integer
18802 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18803 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18804
18805ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018806 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18807 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18808 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810 Example :
18811 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18812 listen http-https
18813 bind :80
18814 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18815 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18816
18817ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18818 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18819 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18820
18821ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018822 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018823 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018824 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18826 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18827 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18828 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18829 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18830 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832ssl_fc_cipher : string
18833 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18834 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018835
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018836ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18837 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18838 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018839 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018840
18841ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18842 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18843 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018844 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018845
18846ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18847 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18848 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18849 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018850 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018851 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018852
18853ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18854 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18855 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018856 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018857
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018858ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18859 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18860 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18861 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18862
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018863ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18864 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18865 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18866 transport layer.
18867 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18868 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18869 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18870 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18871
18872ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18873 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18874 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18875 transport layer.
18876 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18877 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18878 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18879 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18880
18881ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18882 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18883 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18884 transport layer.
18885 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18886 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18887 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18888 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18889
18890ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18891 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18892 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18893 transport layer.
18894 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18895 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18896 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18897 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18898
18899ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18900 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18901 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18902 transport layer.
18903 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18904 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18905 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18906 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018908ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018909 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18910 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018911 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18912 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18913 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18914 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018915
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018916ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18917 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18918 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18919 wait until the handshake happened.
18920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018921ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18922 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018923 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18924 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018925 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018926 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018927
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018928ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018929 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018930 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18931 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018934 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018935 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018936 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18937 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18938 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18939 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18940 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18941 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943ssl_fc_protocol : string
18944 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18945 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018946
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018947ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018948 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018949 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18950 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018951
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018952ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18953 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18954 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18955 transport layer.
18956 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18957 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18958 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18959 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18960
18961ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18962 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18963 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18964 transport layer.
18965 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18966 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18967 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18968 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18969
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018970ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18971 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18972 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18973 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18976 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18977 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18978 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18979 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018980
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018981ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18982 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18983 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18984 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18985 BoringSSL.
18986
18987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988ssl_fc_sni : string
18989 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18990 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018991 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018992 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18993 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18994
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018995 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018996 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018998 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018999 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19003 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019005ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19006 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19007 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019008
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019009ssl_s_der : binary
19010 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19011 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19012 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19013
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019014ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19015 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19016 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19017 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019018 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019019 does not support resumed sessions.
19020
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019021ssl_s_key_alg : string
19022 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19023 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19024 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19025
19026ssl_s_notafter : string
19027 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19028 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19029 transport layer.
19030
19031ssl_s_notbefore : string
19032 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19033 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19034 transport layer.
19035
19036ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19037 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19038 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19039 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19040 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19041 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19042 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019043 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19044 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019045 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19046 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19047 LDAP v3.
19048 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19049 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19050
19051ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19052 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19053 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19054 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19055 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19056 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19057 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019058 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19059 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019060 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19061 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19062 LDAP v3.
19063 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19064 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19065
19066ssl_s_serial : binary
19067 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19068 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19069 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19070
19071ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19072 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19073 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19074 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19075
19076ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19077 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19078 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19079 layer.
19080
19081ssl_s_version : integer
19082 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19083 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190857.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19089sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19090only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19091For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19092be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19093can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19094sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19095for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19096content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019097
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019098Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19099 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019100 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019101 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19102 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19103 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19104 sample expression). So be careful.
19105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019107 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19109 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19112 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019113 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019114 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116req.len : integer
19117req_len : integer (deprecated)
19118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19119 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19120 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19121 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19122 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019123 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19125 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019127req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19128 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019129 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19130 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19131 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19132 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134 ACL alternatives :
19135 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19138 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19139 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19140 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19141 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 ACL alternatives :
19144 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019146 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148req.proto_http : boolean
19149req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19150 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19151 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19152 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19153 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19154 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19155 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19156 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158 Example:
19159 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19160 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19161 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019162 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19165rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19166 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19167 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19168 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19169 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19170 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19171 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19172 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19175 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19176 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19177 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19178 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19179 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019181 ACL derivatives :
19182 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019184 Example :
19185 listen tse-farm
19186 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19187 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19188 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19189 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19190 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19191 persist rdp-cookie
19192 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19193 # This is only useful makes sense if
19194 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19195 stick-table type string size 204800
19196 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19197 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19198 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019200 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19201 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19204rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19205 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19206 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19207 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19208 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210 ACL derivatives :
19211 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019212
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019213req.ssl_alpn : string
19214 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19215 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19216 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19217 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19218 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19219 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019220 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019221
19222 Examples :
19223 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19224 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19225 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019226 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019227 default_backend bk_default
19228
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019229req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19230 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19231 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019232 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19233 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19234 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19235 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19236 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19239req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19240 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19241 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19242 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19243 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19244 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19245 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19246 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248req.ssl_sni : string
19249req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19250 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19251 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19252 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19253 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19254 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019255 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19256 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19257 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19258 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19259 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19260 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19261 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19262 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19263 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019266 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 Examples :
19269 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19270 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19271 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019272 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019273 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019274
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019275req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19276 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19277 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19278 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19279 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19280 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19281 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19282 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19283 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19284 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019286req.ssl_ver : integer
19287req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19288 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19289 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19290 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19291 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19292 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19293 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19294 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019295 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298 ACL derivatives :
19299 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019300
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019301res.len : integer
19302 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19303 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19304 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19305 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19306 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019307 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019308 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019309 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019311res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19312 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019313 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019314 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019315 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019316 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019318res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19319 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19320 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19321 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019322 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19323 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019326
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019327res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19328rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19329 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19330 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19331 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19332 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19333 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19334 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19335 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019337wait_end : boolean
19338 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19339 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019340 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19342 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019343 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019344 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19345 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347 Examples :
19348 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19349 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19350 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19353 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19354 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19355 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19356 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19357 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19358 tcp-request content reject
19359
19360
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193617.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019362--------------------------------------
19363
19364It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19365This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19366data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19367its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19368HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19369content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19370to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19371more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19372response are indexed.
19373
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019374Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19375 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19376 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19377 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19378 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19379 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19380 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382base : string
19383 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19384 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19385 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19386 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19387 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19388 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19389 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19390 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19391
19392 ACL derivatives :
19393 base : exact string match
19394 base_beg : prefix match
19395 base_dir : subdir match
19396 base_dom : domain match
19397 base_end : suffix match
19398 base_len : length match
19399 base_reg : regex match
19400 base_sub : substring match
19401
19402base32 : integer
19403 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19404 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19405 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019406 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19407 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19408 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019409
19410base32+src : binary
19411 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19412 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19413 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19414 per-URL counters.
19415
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019416baseq : string
19417 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19418 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19419 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19420 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19421
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019422capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19423 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19424 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19425 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19426
19427capture.req.method : string
19428 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19429 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19430 because it's allocated.
19431
19432capture.req.uri : string
19433 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19434 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19435 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19436 allocated.
19437
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019438capture.req.ver : string
19439 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19440 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19441 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19442
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019443capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19444 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19445 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19446 The first entry is an index of 0.
19447 See also: "capture response header"
19448
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019449capture.res.ver : string
19450 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19451 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19452 persistent flag.
19453
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019454req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019455 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19456 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19457 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019458
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019459req.body_param([<name>) : string
19460 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19461 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19462 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19463 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19464 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19465 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19466 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19467 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19468 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19469 given.
19470
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019471req.body_len : integer
19472 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19473 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019474 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19475 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019476
19477req.body_size : integer
19478 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019479 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19480 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482req.cook([<name>]) : string
19483cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19484 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19485 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19486 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19487 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19488 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19489 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19490 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19491 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19492
19493 ACL derivatives :
19494 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19495 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19496 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19497 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19498 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19499 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19500 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19501 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19504cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19505 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19506 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19509cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19510 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19511 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19512 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19513 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019515cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19516 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19517 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19518 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19519 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019520 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19522 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19523 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19524 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19527 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19528 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19529 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19530 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019531 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019533req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019534 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19535 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19536 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19537 with headers such as User-Agent.
19538
19539 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19540 found.
19541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19543 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19544 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019545 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19548 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19549 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019550 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19551 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019553req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019554 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19555 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19556 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19557 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19558 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19559 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19560 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19561
19562 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19563 found.
19564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019565 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19566 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19567 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019568 with -1 being the last one.
19569
19570 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19571 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019573 ACL derivatives :
19574 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19575 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19576 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19577 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19578 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19579 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19580 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19581 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19582
19583req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19584hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19585 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19586 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019587 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19588 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19589 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19590
19591 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19592 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19593 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19594
19595 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019596
19597req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19598hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19600 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19601 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019602 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19603 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19604 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19605 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19606 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019607
19608 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19609
19610 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019611
19612req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19613hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19614 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19615 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19616 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019617
19618 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19619
19620 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019621
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019622req.hdrs : string
19623 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19624 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19625 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19626 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19627
19628req.hdrs_bin : binary
19629 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19630 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19631 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19632 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19633 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19634 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19635
19636 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019637
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019638 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19639 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19642 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19643 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19644 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19645 basic auth is supported.
19646
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019647http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19648 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19649 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19650 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19651 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19653 basic auth is supported.
19654
19655 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019656 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19657 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19658 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19659 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019661http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019662 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19663 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19664 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019665
19666http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019667 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19668 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19669 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019670
19671http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019672 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19673 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19674 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019676http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019677 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19678 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19680 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019682method : integer + string
19683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19684 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19685 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19686 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19687 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19688 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19689 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019691 ACL derivatives :
19692 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694 Example :
19695 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19696 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19697 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699path : string
19700 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19701 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19702 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19703 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19704 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019705 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019706 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708 ACL derivatives :
19709 path : exact string match
19710 path_beg : prefix match
19711 path_dir : subdir match
19712 path_dom : domain match
19713 path_end : suffix match
19714 path_len : length match
19715 path_reg : regex match
19716 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019717
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019718pathq : string
19719 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19720 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19721 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19722 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19723 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19724 result in both cases.
19725
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019726query : string
19727 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19728 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19729 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19730 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019731 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019732 which stops before the question mark.
19733
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019734req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19735 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19736 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19737 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19738 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740req.ver : string
19741req_ver : string (deprecated)
19742 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19743 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19744 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019746 ACL derivatives :
19747 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019748
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019749res.body : binary
19750 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19751 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019752 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19753
19754 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019755
19756res.body_len : integer
19757 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19758 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019759 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19760
19761 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019762
19763res.body_size : integer
19764 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19765 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19766 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19767 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019768 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19769
19770 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019771
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019772res.cache_hit : boolean
19773 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19774 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19775
19776res.cache_name : string
19777 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19778 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19779 empty string.
19780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019781res.comp : boolean
19782 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19783 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19784 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019786res.comp_algo : string
19787 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19788 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19789 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791res.cook([<name>]) : string
19792scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19793 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19794 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019795 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19796
19797 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019799 ACL derivatives :
19800 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19803scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19804 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19805 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019806 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19807
19808 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019810res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19811scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19812 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19813 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019814 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19815
19816 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019819 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19820 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19821
19822 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19823 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19824
19825 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19826
19827 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019830 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19831 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19832
19833 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19834 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19835
19836 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019838res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19839shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019840 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19841 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19842
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019843 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019844 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19845
19846 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848 ACL derivatives :
19849 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19850 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19851 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19852 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19853 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19854 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19855 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19856 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19857
19858res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19859shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019860 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19861 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19862
19863 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019864 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019865
19866 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019868res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19869shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019870 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19871 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19872
19873 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19874
19875 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019876
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019877res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19878 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19879 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19880 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019881 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19882
19883 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19886shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019887 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19888 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19889
19890 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19891
19892 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019893
19894res.hdrs : string
19895 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19896 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19897 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019898 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19899
19900 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019901
19902res.hdrs_bin : binary
19903 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19904 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19905 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19906 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19907 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19908 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19909 (length of 0 for both).
19910
19911 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19912
19913 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19914 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916res.ver : string
19917resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19918 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019919 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19920
19921 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019923 ACL derivatives :
19924 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019926set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19927 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19928 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019929 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019930 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19933 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019935status : integer
19936 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19937 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019938 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19939
19940 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019941
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019942unique-id : string
19943 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19944 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19945 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19946 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19947 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19948 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019950url : string
19951 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19952 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19953 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19954 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19955 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19956 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19957 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959 ACL derivatives :
19960 url : exact string match
19961 url_beg : prefix match
19962 url_dir : subdir match
19963 url_dom : domain match
19964 url_end : suffix match
19965 url_len : length match
19966 url_reg : regex match
19967 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019969url_ip : ip
19970 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19971 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19972 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19973 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020019974 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
19975 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019977url_port : integer
19978 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020019979 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019980
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019981urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19982url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019983 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19984 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019985 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19986 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19987 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19988 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019989 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19990 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019991 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19992 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019994 ACL derivatives :
19995 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19996 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19997 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19998 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19999 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20000 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20001 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20002 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020003
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005 Example :
20006 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20007 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20008 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20009 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020010
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020011urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020012 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20013 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20014 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020015
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020016url32 : integer
20017 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20018 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20019 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20020 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20021 is an unsigned integer.
20022
20023url32+src : binary
20024 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20025 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20026 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20027
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020028
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200297.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020030---------------------------------------
20031
20032This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20033used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20034purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20035There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20036or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20037any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20038for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20039
20040internal.htx.data : integer
20041 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20042 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20043
20044internal.htx.free : integer
20045 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20046 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20047
20048internal.htx.free_data : integer
20049 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20050 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20051
20052internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020053 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20054 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20055 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020056
20057internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20058 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20059 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20060
20061internal.htx.size : integer
20062 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20063 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20064
20065internal.htx.used : integer
20066 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20067 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20068 direction.
20069
20070internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20071 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20072 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20073 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20074 of the special value :
20075 * head : The oldest inserted block
20076 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020077 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020078
20079internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20080 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20081 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20082 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20083 integer or one of the special value :
20084 * head : The oldest inserted block
20085 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020086 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020087
20088internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20089 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20090 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20091 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20092 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20093
20094 * head : The oldest inserted block
20095 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020096 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020097
20098internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20099 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20100 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20101 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20102 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20103
20104 * head : The oldest inserted block
20105 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020106 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020107
20108internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20109 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20110 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20111 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20112 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20113
20114 * head : The oldest inserted block
20115 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020116 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020117
20118internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20119 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20120 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20121 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20122 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20123
20124 * head : The oldest inserted block
20125 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020126 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020127
20128internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20129 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20130 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20131 it returns false.
20132
20133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201347.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020135---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020137Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20138every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020139order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020141ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020142---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20143FALSE always_false never match
20144HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20145HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20146HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020147HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020148HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20149HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20150HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20151HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20152LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20153METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20154METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20155METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20156METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20157METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20158METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20159METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20160METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20161RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20162REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20163TRUE always_true always match
20164WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20165---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020166
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201688. Logging
20169----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020170
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020171One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20172provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20173very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20174provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20175state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020176to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020177headers.
20178
20179In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20180about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20181send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20182
20183 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20184 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20185 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20186 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20187 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020188 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020189 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020190
20191The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20192allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20193as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20194while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20195real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20196delay.
20197
20198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201998.1. Log levels
20200---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020201
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020202TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020203source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020204HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20205in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20206track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20207syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20208about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020209
20210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202118.2. Log formats
20212----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020214HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020215and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20216slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20217options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020218
20219 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20220 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20221 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20222 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20223 extents.
20224
20225 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20226 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20227 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20228 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20229 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20230
20231 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20232 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20233 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20234 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20235 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20236
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020237 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20238 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20239 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20240 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20241
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020242 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20245specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20246field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20247servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20248always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20249identifier.
20250
20251Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20252 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20253 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20254 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20255 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20256
20257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202588.2.1. Default log format
20259-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020260
20261This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20262as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20263format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20264
20265 Example :
20266 listen www
20267 mode http
20268 log global
20269 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20270
20271 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20272 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20273 (www/HTTP)
20274
20275 Field Format Extract from the example above
20276 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20277 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20278 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20279 4 'to' to
20280 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20281 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20282
20283Detailed fields description :
20284 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20285 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20286 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20287 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20288 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20289 and processed the connection.
20290 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20291
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020292In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20293"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20294connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20295
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020296It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20297will eventually disappear.
20298
20299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203008.2.2. TCP log format
20301---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020302
20303The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20304is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20305information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20306counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20307emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20308environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20309the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20310sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020311specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20312not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20313fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20314marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020315
20316 Example :
20317 frontend fnt
20318 mode tcp
20319 option tcplog
20320 log global
20321 default_backend bck
20322
20323 backend bck
20324 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20325
20326 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20327 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20328 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20329
20330 Field Format Extract from the example above
20331 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20332 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20333 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20334 4 frontend_name fnt
20335 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20336 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20337 7 bytes_read* 212
20338 8 termination_state --
20339 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20340 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20341
20342Detailed fields description :
20343 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020344 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020345 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20346 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020347 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020348 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020349 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020350
20351 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020352 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20353 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20354 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020355
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020356 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020357 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20358 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020359 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20360 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20361 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20362 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020363
20364 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20365 and processed the connection.
20366
20367 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20368 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20369 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20370 applications.
20371
20372 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20373 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20374 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20375 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20376 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20377
20378 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20379 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20380 See "Timers" below for more details.
20381
20382 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20383 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20384 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20385 "Timers" below for more details.
20386
20387 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020388 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20390 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20391 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20392 details.
20393
20394 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20395 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20396 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20397 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20398 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20399
20400 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20401 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20402 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20403 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20404 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20405 for more details.
20406
20407 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020408 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020409 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20410 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20411 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020412 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020413
20414 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20415 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20416 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20417 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20418 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20419 caused by a denial of service attack.
20420
20421 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20422 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20423 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20424 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20425 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20426 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20427 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20428 denial of service attack.
20429
20430 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20431 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20432 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20433 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20434 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20435 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20436 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20437 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20438 be processed than on other servers.
20439
20440 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20441 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20442 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20443 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020444 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020445 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20446 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20447 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20448 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20449 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20450 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20451 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20452 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20453
20454 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20455 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20456 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20457 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20458 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20459 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020460 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020461 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20462
20463 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20464 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20465 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20466 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20467 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20468 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020469 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020470 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20471 occurs.
20472
20473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204748.2.3. HTTP log format
20475----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020476
20477The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20478is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20479the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20480are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20481emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20482generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20483"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20484which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020485frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20486is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020487
20488Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20489slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20490with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20491
20492 Example :
20493 frontend http-in
20494 mode http
20495 option httplog
20496 log global
20497 default_backend bck
20498
20499 backend static
20500 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20501
20502 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20503 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20504 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020505 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020506
20507 Field Format Extract from the example above
20508 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20509 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020510 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020511 4 frontend_name http-in
20512 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020513 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020514 7 status_code 200
20515 8 bytes_read* 2750
20516 9 captured_request_cookie -
20517 10 captured_response_cookie -
20518 11 termination_state ----
20519 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20520 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20521 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20522 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20523 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020524
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020525Detailed fields description :
20526 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020527 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020528 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20529 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020530 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020531 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020532 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020533
20534 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020535 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20536 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20537 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020538
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020539 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020540 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020541
20542 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20543 and processed the connection.
20544
20545 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20546 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20547 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20548
20549 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20550 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20551 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20552 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20553 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20554 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20555
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020556 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20557 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20558 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020559 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020560 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20561 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020562 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020563 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020564
20565 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20566 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020567 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020568
20569 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20570 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020571 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20572 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020573
20574 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20575 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20576 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20577 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20578 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020579 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20580 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020581
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020582 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020583 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20584 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20585 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20586 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20587 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20588 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020589 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590
20591 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020592 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20593 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020594
20595 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20596 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020597 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020598 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20599 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20600 overflowing.
20601
20602 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20603 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20604 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20605 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20606 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20607 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20608 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20609 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20610
20611 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20612 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20613 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20614 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20615 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20616 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20617 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20618 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20619
20620 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20621 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20622 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20623 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20624 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20625 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20626 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20627
20628 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020629 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020630 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20631 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20632 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020633 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020634 system.
20635
20636 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20637 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20638 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20639 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20640 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20641 caused by a denial of service attack.
20642
20643 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20644 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20645 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20646 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20647 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20648 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20649 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20650 denial of service attack.
20651
20652 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20653 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20654 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20655 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20656 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20657 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20658 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20659 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20660 processed than on other servers.
20661
20662 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20663 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20664 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20665 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020666 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020667 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20668 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20669 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20670 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20671 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20672 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20673 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20674 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20675
20676 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20677 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20678 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20679 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20680 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20681 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020682 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020683 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20684
20685 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20686 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20687 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20688 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20689 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20690 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020691 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20693 occurs.
20694
20695 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20696 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20697 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20698 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20699 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20700 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20701 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20702 cookies" below for more details.
20703
20704 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20705 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20706 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20707 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20708 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20709 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20710 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20711 and cookies" below for more details.
20712
20713 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20714 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20715 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20716 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20717 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20718 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20719 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20720 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20721
20722
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207238.2.4. Custom log format
20724------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020725
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020726The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020727mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020729HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020730Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20731separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20732prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20733
20734Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20735variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020736("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020737
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020738If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020739as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020740less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20741the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20742
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020743Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20744"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20745delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20746preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020747
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020748Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20749'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20750https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20751such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20752
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020753Flags are :
20754 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020755 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020756 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20757 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020758
20759 Example:
20760
20761 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20762 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20763
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020764 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20765
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020766At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20767
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020768 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20769 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020770
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020771the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020772
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020773 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20774 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20775 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020776
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020777and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20778
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020779 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20780 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020781
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020782Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20783
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020784 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020785 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020786 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20787 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20788 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020789 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20790 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20791 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020792 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020793 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020794 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020795 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020796 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020797 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20798 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020799 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020800 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020801 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020802 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020803 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020804 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020805 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020806 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20807 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20808 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20809 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20810 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020811 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020812 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020813 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020814 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020815 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020816 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20817 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020818 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20819 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20820 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020821 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020822 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20823 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020824 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020825 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20826 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20827 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020828 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020829 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020830 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20831 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20832 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20833 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020834 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020835 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020836 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020837 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020838 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020839 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020840 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20841 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20842 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020843 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020844 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20845 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020846 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020847 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20848 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020849 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020850 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020851 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020852 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020853
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020854 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020855
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020856
208578.2.5. Error log format
20858-----------------------
20859
20860When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020861protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020862By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20863"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020864will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020865logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20866
20867The format looks like this :
20868
20869 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20870 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20871 Connection error during SSL handshake
20872
20873 Field Format Extract from the example above
20874 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20875 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20876 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20877 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20878 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20879
20880These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20881failures.
20882
20883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208848.3. Advanced logging options
20885-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020886
20887Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20888just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20889options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20890for more information about their usage.
20891
20892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208938.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20894------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020895
20896It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020897HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020898commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20899monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20900ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20901
20902 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20903 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20904 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20905 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20906
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020907 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20908 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020909
20910 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20911 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20912 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20913
20914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20916----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020917
20918The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20919what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20920or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020921"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020922just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20923log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20924after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20925is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20926with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20927with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20928
20929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20931------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020932
20933Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20934for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20935"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20936retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20937raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20938a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20939file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20940you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20941"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20942
20943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20945--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020946
20947Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20948multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20949them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20950"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20951logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20952error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20953and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20954too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20955useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20956alternative.
20957
20958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209598.4. Timing events
20960------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020961
20962Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20963reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20964the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20965frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020966mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20967addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20968
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020969Timings events in HTTP mode:
20970
20971 first request 2nd request
20972 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20973 t tr t tr ...
20974 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20975 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20976 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20977 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020978 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020979 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20980
20981Timings events in TCP mode:
20982
20983 TCP session
20984 |<----------------->|
20985 t t
20986 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20987 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20988 |<------ Tt ------->|
20989
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020990 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020991 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020992 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20993 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20994 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020995 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020996 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20997 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20998 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20999 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021001 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21002 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21003 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021004 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21005 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21006 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21007 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21008 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21009 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021010
21011 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21012 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21013 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21014 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21015 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21016 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21017 request typed by hand during a test.
21018
21019 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21020 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021021 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021022 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21023 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21024 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21025 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021026
21027 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21028 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21029 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21030 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21031 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21032
21033 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21034 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21035 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21036 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21037 connection never established.
21038
21039 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21040 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21041 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21042 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21043 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21044 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21045 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21046 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21047 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21048 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21049 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21050
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021051 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21052 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21053 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21054 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21055 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21056 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21057
21058 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21059
21060 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21061 "Ta" can never be negative.
21062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21064 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021065 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21066 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021067 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021069 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070
21071 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021072 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21073 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021074
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021075 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21076 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21077 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21078 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21079 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21080 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21081 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21082 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21083
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21085protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21086that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021087due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21088"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21089that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021090
21091Most common cases :
21092
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021093 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21094 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21095 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21096 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21097 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021098 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021099 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21100 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21101 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21102 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21103 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021104 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021105
21106 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21107 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21108 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21109 of ms on remote networks.
21110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021111 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21112 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21113 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021114
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021115 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21116 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021117 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021118 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21119 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21120 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21121 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21122 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21123 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
21125Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21126
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021127 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021129 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021131 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021132 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21133 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021135 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21137 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21138 flags.
21139
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021140 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21141 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21143 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21144 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21145 the client connection was maintained open.
21146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021147 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021148 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021149 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21151
21152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211538.5. Session state at disconnection
21154-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155
21156TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21157"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211582-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21159each of which has a special meaning :
21160
21161 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21162 session to terminate :
21163
21164 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21165
21166 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21167 server explicitly refused it.
21168
21169 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21170 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21171 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21172 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021173 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021174
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021175 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021176 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021177
21178 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21179 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21180 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21181 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21182 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21183
21184 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21185 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21186 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21187 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21188 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21189
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021190 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021191 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021193 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021194 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21195 backup connections when going up.
21196
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021197 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021198
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021199 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21200 send or receive data.
21201
21202 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21203 send or receive data.
21204
21205 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21206 with nothing left in the buffers.
21207
21208 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21209
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021210 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21212
21213 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21214 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21215 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21216 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21217 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21218
21219 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21220 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21221
21222 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21223 server (HTTP only).
21224
21225 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21226
21227 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21228 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21229 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21230
21231 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21232 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21233 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21234
21235 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21236
21237 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21238 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21239
21240 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21241 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21242 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21243
21244 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21245 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021246 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21247 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021248
21249 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21250 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21251 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21252 another server.
21253
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021254 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255 server.
21256
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021257 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21258 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21259 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21260 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21261
21262 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21263 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21264 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21265 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21266
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021267 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21268 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21269 "use-server" rule).
21270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21272
21273 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21274 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21275
21276 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21277
21278 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21279 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21280 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21281
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021282 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21283 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021284 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021285 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21286 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021288 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21289
21290 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21291 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21292
21293 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21294
21295 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21296
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021297The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21298was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21300starvation, attacks, etc...
21301
21302The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21303alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21304easier finding and understanding.
21305
21306 Flags Reason
21307
21308 -- Normal termination.
21309
21310 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021311 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21312 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021313 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21314
21315 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21316 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021317 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21318 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021319 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21320 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021321
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021322 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21323 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021324 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021325
21326 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21327 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21328 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21329
21330 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21331 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21332 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21333 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21334 the server takes too long to respond.
21335
21336 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21337 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21338 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21339 long a time to respond.
21340
21341 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21342 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21343 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021344 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021345 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21346 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021347
21348 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21349 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21350 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21351 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21352 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021353 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021354 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21355 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21356 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21357 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21358 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21359 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21360 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21361 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021362 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021363 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21364 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21365 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021366
21367 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21368 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021369 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21370 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21371 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21372 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021373
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021374 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021375 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21376
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021377 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021378 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21379 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021380 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021381 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21382 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21383
21384 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21385 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21386 503 or 504 here.
21387
21388 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021389 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021390 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21391 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21392 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21393
21394 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21395 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021396 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021397 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021398 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399
21400 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21401 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21402 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21403 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21404 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21405 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021406 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407
21408 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21409 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21410 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21411 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21412 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21413 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21414 solution is to fix the application.
21415
21416 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21417 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21418 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21419 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21420 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21421 external attacks.
21422
21423 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021424 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021425 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021426 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21427 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21428
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021429 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21430 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21431 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021432 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021433 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21436 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21437 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21438 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021439 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21440 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21441 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21442 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21443 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021444
21445 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21446 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21447 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21448 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21449
21450 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21451 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21452 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21453 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21454
21455 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21456 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21457 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21458 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21459
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021460The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021461persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021462important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21463re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21464
21465 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21466
21467 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21468 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21469 set on a GET request.
21470
21471 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21472 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021473 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021474 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21475
21476 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21477 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21478 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21479
21480 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21481 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21482 already got a cookie.
21483
21484 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21485 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21486 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21487 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21488 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21489
21490 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21491 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21492 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21493
21494 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21495 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21496 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21497
21498 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21499 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21500
21501 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21502 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21503 then advertised in the response.
21504
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215068.6. Non-printable characters
21507-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021508
21509In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21510consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21511converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21512prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21513being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21514escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21515is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21516'}' when logging headers.
21517
21518Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21519issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21520containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21521
21522Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21523the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21524performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21525
21526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21528---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021529
21530Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21531achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021532section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021533cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21534the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21535the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021536locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021537not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21538user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21539a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21540wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21541
21542 Examples :
21543 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21544 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21545
21546 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21547 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21548
21549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21551---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021552
21553Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21554proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21555the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21556server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21557
21558Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21559response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021560section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561
21562It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021563time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21564appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021565are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21566and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21567follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21568request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21569in the logs.
21570
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021571As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21572frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21573an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021575 Example :
21576 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21577 listen proxy-out
21578 mode http
21579 option httplog
21580 option logasap
21581 log global
21582 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21583
21584 # log the name of the virtual server
21585 capture request header Host len 20
21586
21587 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21588 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21589
21590 # log the beginning of the referrer
21591 capture request header Referer len 20
21592
21593 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21594 capture response header Server len 20
21595
21596 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21597 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21598
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021599 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021600 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21601
21602 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21603 capture response header Via len 20
21604
21605 # log the URL location during a redirection
21606 capture response header Location len 20
21607
21608 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21609 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21610 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21611 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21612 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21613
21614 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21615 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21616 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21617 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021618 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021619
21620 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21621 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21622 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21623 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21624 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021625 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021626
21627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216288.9. Examples of logs
21629---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021630
21631These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21632them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21633reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21634
21635 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21636 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21637 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21638
21639 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21640 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21641
21642 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21643 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21644 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21645
21646 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21647 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21648
21649 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21650 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21651 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21652
21653 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021654 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021655 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21656 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21657
21658 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21659 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21660 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21661
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021662 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21663 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21664 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21665 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021666 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021667 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021668
21669 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021670 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021671
21672 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21673 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21674 Nothing was sent to any server.
21675
21676 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21677 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21678
21679 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21680 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021681 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021682 send a 408 return code to the client.
21683
21684 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21685 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21686
21687 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21688 5 seconds ("c----").
21689
21690 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21691 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021692 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021693
21694 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021695 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021696 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21697 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21698 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21699 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21700 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021701
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021702
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200217039. Supported filters
21704--------------------
21705
21706Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21707accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21708unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21709
21710See also : "filter"
21711
217129.1. Trace
21713----------
21714
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021715filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021716
21717 Arguments:
21718 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21719 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21720
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021721 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021723 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021724 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21725 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21726 amount of the parsed data.
21727
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021728 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021729
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021730This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21731callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21732information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21733filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21734
21735Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21736tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21737a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21738
21739
217409.2. HTTP compression
21741---------------------
21742
21743filter compression
21744
21745The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21746keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021747when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21748fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21749done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21750explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21751filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21752listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21753order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021754
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021755See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21756 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021757
21758
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21760--------------------------------------------
21761
21762filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21763
21764 Arguments :
21765
21766 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21767 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21768 parsed.
21769
21770 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21771 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21772 part must be placed in its own scope.
21773
21774The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21775external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021776streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021777exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21778also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21779
21780SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21781the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21782
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021783For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021784"doc/SPOE.txt".
21785
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217869.4. Cache
21787----------
21788
21789filter cache <name>
21790
21791 Arguments :
21792
21793 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21794
21795The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21796"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021797cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021798other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21799case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21800is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21801filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021802listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21803order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021804
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021805See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21806 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21807
21808
218099.5. Fcgi-app
21810-------------
21811
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021812filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021813
21814 Arguments :
21815
21816 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21817
21818The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21819request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21820reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21821used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21822implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21823used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21824fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21825used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21826order.
21827
21828See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21829 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21830
21831
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218329.6. OpenTracing
21833----------------
21834
21835The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21836HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21837of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21838Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21839
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021840This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021841
21842The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21843HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21844participates in the work of HAProxy.
21845
21846filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21847
21848 Arguments :
21849
21850 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21851 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21852 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21853 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21854 OpenTracing filters.
21855
21856 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21857 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21858 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21859 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21860 filter must have its own scope defined.
21861
21862More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021863of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021864
21865
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002186610. FastCGI applications
21867-------------------------
21868
21869HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21870feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21871the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21872FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21873servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21874FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21875backend.
21876
21877HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21878application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21879connection.
21880
2188110.1. Setup
21882-----------
21883
2188410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21885--------------------------
21886
21887fcgi-app <name>
21888 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21889 document root must be defined.
21890
21891acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21892 Declare or complete an access list.
21893
21894 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21895 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21896 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21897 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21898 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21899
21900docroot <path>
21901 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21902 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21903 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21904
21905index <script-name>
21906 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21907 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21908 is an optional setting.
21909
21910 Example :
21911 index index.php
21912
21913log-stderr global
21914log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021915 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021916 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21917
21918 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21919 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21920
21921pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21922 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21923 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21924 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21925
21926 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21927 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21928 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21929 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21930
21931 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21932 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21933
21934path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021935 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021936 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21937 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21938 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21939 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21940 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21941 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21942 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021943
21944 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021945 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021946 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21947 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21948 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21949 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021950
21951 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021952 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21953 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021954
21955option get-values
21956no option get-values
21957 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21958
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021959 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021960 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21961
21962 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21963 application will accept.
21964
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021965 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21966 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021967
21968 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021969 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021970 option is disabled.
21971
21972 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21973 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21974 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21975 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21976 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21977 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21978
21979option keep-conn
21980no option keep-conn
21981 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21982 sending a response.
21983
21984 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21985 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21986
21987option max-reqs <reqs>
21988 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21989 accept.
21990
21991 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21992 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21993 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21994 to 1.
21995
21996option mpxs-conns
21997no option mpxs-conns
21998 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21999
22000 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22001 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22002
22003set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22004 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22005 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22006 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22007 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22008
22009 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22010 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22011 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22012
22013 Example :
22014 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22015 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22016
22017 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22018
22019
2202010.1.2. Proxy section
22021---------------------
22022
22023use-fcgi-app <name>
22024 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22025
22026 Arguments :
22027 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22028
22029 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22030 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22031 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22032 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22033 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22034
22035 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22036 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22037 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22038 application are evaluated.
22039
22040
2204110.1.3. Example
22042---------------
22043
22044 frontend front-http
22045 mode http
22046 bind *:80
22047 bind *:
22048
22049 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22050 default_backend back-static
22051
22052 backend back-static
22053 mode http
22054 server www A.B.C.D:80
22055
22056 backend back-dynamic
22057 mode http
22058 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22059 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22060
22061 fcgi-app php-fpm
22062 log-stderr global
22063 option keep-conn
22064
22065 docroot /var/www/my-app
22066 index index.php
22067 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22068
22069
2207010.2. Default parameters
22071------------------------
22072
22073A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22074the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022075script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022076applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22077
22078 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22079 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22080 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22081 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22082 | | |
22083 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22084 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22085 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22086 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22087 | | application. |
22088 | | |
22089 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22090 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22091 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22092 | | |
22093 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22094 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22095 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22096 | | the application's configuration. |
22097 | | |
22098 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22099 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22100 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22101 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22102 | | |
22103 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22104 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22105 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22106 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22107 | | be defined. |
22108 | | |
22109 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22110 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22111 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22112 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22113 | | is not set too. |
22114 | | |
22115 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22116 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22117 | | set. |
22118 | | |
22119 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22120 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22121 | | the request. |
22122 | | |
22123 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22124 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22125 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22126 | | |
22127 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22128 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22129 | | script to process the request. |
22130 | | |
22131 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22132 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22133 | | |
22134 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22135 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22136 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22137 | | |
22138 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22139 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22140 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22141 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22142 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22143 | | |
22144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22145 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22146 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22147 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22148 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22149 | | side. |
22150 | | |
22151 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22152 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22153 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22154 | | connected to. |
22155 | | |
22156 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22157 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22158 | | |
22159 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022160 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22161 | | current HAProxy version. |
22162 | | |
22163 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022164 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22165 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22166 | | |
22167 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22168
22169
2217010.3. Limitations
22171------------------
22172
22173The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22174way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22175during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22176establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22177application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22178or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22179message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22180these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22181and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22182
22183Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22184request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22185requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22186
22187About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22188into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22189fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22190"http-request" ones.
22191
22192Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22193FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22194processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22195must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22196here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022197
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022198
2219911. Address formats
22200-------------------
22201
22202Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22203address.
22204
22205This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22206The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22207of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22208equivalent is '::'.
22209
22210Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22211is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22212
22213This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22214family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22215
22216Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22217configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22218use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22219'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22220
22221Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22222socket type and the transport method.
22223
22224
2222511.1 Address family prefixes
22226----------------------------
22227
22228'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22229
22230'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22231 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22232 listening.
22233
22234'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22235 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22236 on the statement using this address, a port or
22237 a port range may or must be specified.
22238
22239'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22240 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22241 using this address, a port or a port range
22242 may or must be specified.
22243
22244'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22245 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22246 using this address, a port or a port range
22247 may or must be specified.
22248
22249'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22250 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22251 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22252 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22253 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22254 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22255
22256'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22257 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22258 start by slash '/'.
22259
22260
2226111.2 Socket type prefixes
22262-------------------------
22263
22264Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22265type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22266this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22267This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22268but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22269
22270Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22271instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22272
22273If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22274they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22275report this to the maintainers.
22276
22277'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22278 to "stream"
22279
22280'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22281 to "datagram".
22282
22283
2228411.3 Protocol prefixes
22285----------------------
22286
22287'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22288 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22289 socket type and transport method is forced to
22290 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22291 this address, a port or a port range can or
22292 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22293 of 'stream+ip@'.
22294
22295'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22296 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22297 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22298 statement using this address, a port or port
22299 range can or must be specified.
22300 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22301
22302'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22303 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22304 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22305 statement using this address, a port or port
22306 range can or must be specified.
22307 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22308
22309'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22310 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22311 socket type and transport method is forced to
22312 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22313 this address, a port or a port range can or
22314 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22315 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22316
22317'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22318 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22319 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22320 the statement using this address, a port or
22321 port range can or must be specified.
22322 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22323
22324'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22325 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22326 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22327 the statement using this address, a port or
22328 port range can or must be specified.
22329 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22330
22331'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22332 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22333 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22334
22335'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22336 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22337 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22338
22339In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22340QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022342/*
22343 * Local variables:
22344 * fill-column: 79
22345 * End:
22346 */